bind_c_array_params_2.f90: Add "-mno-explicit-relocs" for alpha*-*-* targets.
[gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
6 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
7 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8
9 This file is part of GCC.
10
11 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
12 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
13 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
14 version.
15
16 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
17 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
18 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
19 for more details.
20
21 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
23 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
24
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
36
37 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
38
39 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
40 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
41 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
42 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
43 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
44
45 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
46 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
47
48 CIE = Common Information Entry
49 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
50
51 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
52
53 FDE = Frame Description Entry
54 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
55 how to restore registers
56
57 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
58 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
59
60 #include "config.h"
61 #include "system.h"
62 #include "coretypes.h"
63 #include "tm.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "version.h"
66 #include "flags.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "except.h"
76 #include "dwarf2.h"
77 #include "dwarf2out.h"
78 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
79 #include "toplev.h"
80 #include "ggc.h"
81 #include "md5.h"
82 #include "tm_p.h"
83 #include "diagnostic.h"
84 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
85 #include "debug.h"
86 #include "target.h"
87 #include "common/common-target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92 #include "gimple.h"
93 #include "dumpfile.h"
94 #include "opts.h"
95
96 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
97 static rtx last_var_location_insn;
98 static rtx cached_next_real_insn;
99
100 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
101 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
102
103 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
104 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
105 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
106 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
107 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
108 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
109 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
110 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
111 #else
112 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
113 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
114 #endif
115
116 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
117 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
118 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
119 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
120 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
121 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
122 #endif
123
124 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
125 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
126 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
127 #endif
128
129 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
130 must be kept around forever. */
131 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
132
133 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
134 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
135 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
136 it. */
137 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
138
139 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
140 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
141 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
142 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
143 define type declaration DIE's. */
144 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
145
146 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
147 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
148 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
149 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
150 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
151 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
158
159 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
160 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
161
162 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
163 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
164 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
165 bytes.
166
167 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
168 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
169
170 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
171 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
172 #endif
173
174 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
175 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
176 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
177
178 /* CIE identifier. */
179 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
180 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
181 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
182 #else
183 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
184 #endif
185
186 DEF_VEC_P (dw_fde_ref);
187 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_fde_ref, gc);
188
189 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
190 information for each routine. */
191 static GTY(()) VEC(dw_fde_ref, gc) *fde_vec;
192
193 struct GTY(()) indirect_string_node {
194 const char *str;
195 unsigned int refcount;
196 enum dwarf_form form;
197 char *label;
198 };
199
200 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
201
202 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
203
204 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
205 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
206
207 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
208
209 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
210 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
211
212 /* The default cold text section. */
213 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
214
215 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
216
217 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
218 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
219 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
220
221 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
222 personality CFI. */
223 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
224
225 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
226 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
227 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
228
229 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
230 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
231 #endif
232
233 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
234 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
235 #endif
236
237 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
238 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
239 #endif
240
241 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
242 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
243 #endif
244
245 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
246 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
247 #endif
248
249 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
250 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
251 #endif
252 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
253 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
254 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
255 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
256 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
257 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
258 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
259 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
260 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
261 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
262 \f
263 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
264
265 static int
266 matches_main_base (const char *path)
267 {
268 /* Cache the last query. */
269 static const char *last_path = NULL;
270 static int last_match = 0;
271 if (path != last_path)
272 {
273 const char *base;
274 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
275 last_path = path;
276 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
277 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
278 }
279 return last_match;
280 }
281
282 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
283
284 static int
285 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
286 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
287 int matches, int result)
288 {
289 /* Find the type name. */
290 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
291 tree t = type_decl;
292 const char *name = 0;
293 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
294 t = DECL_NAME (t);
295 if (t)
296 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
297
298 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
299 criterion,
300 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
301 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
302 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
303 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
304 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
305 result,
306 (void*) type_decl, name);
307 return result;
308 }
309 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
310 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
311
312 #else
313
314 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
315 (result)
316
317 #endif
318
319 static bool
320 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
321 {
322 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
323 tree type_decl;
324 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
325
326 if (generic)
327 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
328 else
329 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
330
331 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
332 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
333 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
334 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
335
336 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
337
338 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
339 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
340
341 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
342 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
343 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
344 }
345 \f
346 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
347 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
348
349 static inline char *
350 stripattributes (const char *s)
351 {
352 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
353 char *p = stripped;
354
355 *p++ = '*';
356
357 while (*s && *s != ',')
358 *p++ = *s++;
359
360 *p = '\0';
361 return stripped;
362 }
363
364 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
365 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
366 for collect2 the first time around. */
367
368 static void
369 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
370 {
371 tree label;
372
373 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
374 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
375 {
376 int flags;
377
378 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
379 {
380 int fde_encoding;
381 int per_encoding;
382 int lsda_encoding;
383
384 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
385 /*global=*/0);
386 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
387 /*global=*/1);
388 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
389 /*global=*/0);
390 flags = ((! flag_pic
391 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
392 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
393 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
394 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
395 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
396 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
397 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
398 }
399 else
400 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
401 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
402 }
403 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
404
405 if (eh_frame_section)
406 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
407 else
408 {
409 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
410 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
411 switch_to_section (data_section);
412
413 if (!back)
414 {
415 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
416 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
417 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
418 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
419 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
420 }
421 }
422 }
423
424 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
425 FOR_EH. */
426
427 static void
428 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
429 {
430 if (for_eh)
431 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
432 else
433 {
434 if (!debug_frame_section)
435 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
436 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
437 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
438 }
439 }
440
441 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
442
443 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
444 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
445 {
446 switch (cfi)
447 {
448 case DW_CFA_nop:
449 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
450 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
451 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
452 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
453
454 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
455 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
456 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
457 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
458 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
459 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
460
461 case DW_CFA_offset:
462 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
463 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
464 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
465 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
466 case DW_CFA_restore:
467 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
468 case DW_CFA_undefined:
469 case DW_CFA_same_value:
470 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
471 case DW_CFA_register:
472 case DW_CFA_expression:
473 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
474
475 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
476 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
477 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
478 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
479
480 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
481 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
482
483 default:
484 gcc_unreachable ();
485 }
486 }
487
488 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
489
490 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
491 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
492 {
493 switch (cfi)
494 {
495 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
496 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
497 case DW_CFA_offset:
498 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
499 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
500 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
501
502 case DW_CFA_register:
503 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
504
505 case DW_CFA_expression:
506 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
507
508 default:
509 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
510 }
511 }
512
513 /* Output one FDE. */
514
515 static void
516 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
517 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
518 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
519 {
520 const char *begin, *end;
521 static unsigned int j;
522 char l1[20], l2[20];
523
524 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
525 /* empty */ 0);
526 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
527 for_eh + j);
528 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
529 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
530 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
531 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
532 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
533 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
534 "FDE Length");
535 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
536
537 if (for_eh)
538 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
539 else
540 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
541 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
542
543 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
544 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
545
546 if (for_eh)
547 {
548 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
549 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
550 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
551 "FDE initial location");
552 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
553 end, begin, "FDE address range");
554 }
555 else
556 {
557 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
558 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
559 }
560
561 if (augmentation[0])
562 {
563 if (any_lsda_needed)
564 {
565 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
566
567 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
568 {
569 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
570 + 4 /* CIE offset */
571 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
572 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
573 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
574
575 size += pad;
576 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
577 }
578
579 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
580
581 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
582 {
583 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
584 fde->funcdef_number);
585 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
586 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
587 false,
588 "Language Specific Data Area");
589 }
590 else
591 {
592 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
593 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
594 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
595 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
596 }
597 }
598 else
599 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
600 }
601
602 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
603 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
604 {
605 size_t from, until, i;
606
607 from = 0;
608 until = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi);
609
610 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
611 ;
612 else if (!second)
613 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
614 else
615 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
616
617 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
618 output_cfi (VEC_index (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, i), fde, for_eh);
619 }
620
621 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
622 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
623 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
624 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
625 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
626
627 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
628 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
629 switch *back* into the table section. */
630 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
631 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
632 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
633 #endif
634
635 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
636 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
637 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
638 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
639
640 j += 2;
641 }
642
643 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
644
645 static bool
646 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
647 {
648 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
649 return true;
650
651 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
652 return true;
653
654 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
655 return true;
656
657 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
658 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
659 return false;
660
661 return true;
662 }
663
664 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
665 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
666 location of saved registers. */
667
668 static void
669 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
670 {
671 unsigned int i;
672 dw_fde_ref fde;
673 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
674 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
675 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
676 char augmentation[6];
677 int augmentation_size;
678 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
679 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
680 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
681 int return_reg;
682 rtx personality = NULL;
683 int dw_cie_version;
684
685 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
686 if (fde_vec == NULL)
687 return;
688
689 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
690 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
691 return;
692
693 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
694 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
695 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
696 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
697 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
698 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
699 if (for_eh)
700 {
701 bool any_eh_needed = false;
702
703 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_fde_ref, fde_vec, i, fde)
704 {
705 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
706 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
707 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
708 any_eh_needed = true;
709 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
710 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
711 }
712
713 if (!any_eh_needed)
714 return;
715 }
716
717 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
718 if (flag_debug_asm)
719 app_enable ();
720
721 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
722 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
723
724 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
725 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
726
727 /* Output the CIE. */
728 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
729 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
730 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
731 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
732 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
733 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
734 "Length of Common Information Entry");
735 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
736
737 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
738 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
739 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
740 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
741 "CIE Identifier Tag");
742
743 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
744 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
745 due to overflowing the return register column. */
746 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
747 dw_cie_version = 1;
748 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
749 dw_cie_version = 3;
750 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
751
752 augmentation[0] = 0;
753 augmentation_size = 0;
754
755 personality = current_unit_personality;
756 if (for_eh)
757 {
758 char *p;
759
760 /* Augmentation:
761 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
762 augmentation section.
763 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
764 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
765 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
766 FDE code pointers.
767 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
768 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
769
770 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
771 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
772 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
773
774 p = augmentation + 1;
775 if (personality)
776 {
777 *p++ = 'P';
778 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
779 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
780 }
781 if (any_lsda_needed)
782 {
783 *p++ = 'L';
784 augmentation_size += 1;
785 }
786 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
787 {
788 *p++ = 'R';
789 augmentation_size += 1;
790 }
791 if (p > augmentation + 1)
792 {
793 augmentation[0] = 'z';
794 *p = '\0';
795 }
796
797 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
798 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
799 {
800 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
801 + 4 /* CIE Id */
802 + 1 /* CIE version */
803 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
804 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
805 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
806 + 1 /* RA column */
807 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
808 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
809 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
810
811 augmentation_size += pad;
812
813 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
814 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
815 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
816 }
817 }
818
819 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
820 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
821 {
822 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
823 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
824 }
825 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
826 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
827 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
828
829 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
830 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
831 else
832 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
833
834 if (augmentation[0])
835 {
836 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
837 if (personality)
838 {
839 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
840 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
841 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
842 personality,
843 true, NULL);
844 }
845
846 if (any_lsda_needed)
847 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
848 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
849
850 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
851 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
852 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
853 }
854
855 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
856 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
857
858 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
859 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
860 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
861 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
862
863 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
864 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_fde_ref, fde_vec, i, fde)
865 {
866 unsigned int k;
867
868 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
869 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
870 continue;
871
872 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
873 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
874 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
875 }
876
877 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
878 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
879
880 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
881 if (flag_debug_asm)
882 app_disable ();
883 }
884
885 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
886
887 static void
888 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
889 {
890 int enc;
891 rtx ref;
892 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
893
894 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
895
896 if (personality)
897 {
898 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
899 ref = personality;
900
901 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
902 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
903 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
904 of the weirder relocation types. */
905 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
906 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
907
908 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
909 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
910 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
911 }
912
913 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
914 {
915 char lab[20];
916
917 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
918 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
919 current_function_funcdef_no);
920 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
921 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
922
923 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
924 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
925
926 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
927 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
928 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
929 }
930 }
931
932 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
933 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
934
935 dw_fde_ref
936 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
937 {
938 dw_fde_ref fde;
939
940 fde = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_fde_node ();
941 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
942 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
943 fde->fde_index = VEC_length (dw_fde_ref, fde_vec);
944 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
945 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
946 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
947 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
948 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
949
950 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
951 cfun->fde = fde;
952 VEC_safe_push (dw_fde_ref, gc, fde_vec, fde);
953
954 return fde;
955 }
956
957 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
958 the prologue. */
959
960 void
961 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
962 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
963 {
964 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
965 char * dup_label;
966 dw_fde_ref fde;
967 section *fnsec;
968 bool do_frame;
969
970 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
971
972 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
973
974 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
975 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
976 if (!do_frame
977 && (!flag_exceptions
978 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
979 return;
980
981 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
982 switch_to_section (fnsec);
983 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
984 current_function_funcdef_no);
985 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
986 current_function_funcdef_no);
987 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
988 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
989
990 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
991 if (!do_frame)
992 return;
993
994 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
995 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
996 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
997 do so now. */
998 fde = cfun->fde;
999 if (fde == NULL)
1000 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1001
1002 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1003 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1004 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1005 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1006 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1007
1008 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1009 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1010 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1011 if (file)
1012 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
1013 #endif
1014
1015 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1016 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1017 else
1018 {
1019 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1020 if (!current_unit_personality)
1021 current_unit_personality = personality;
1022
1023 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1024 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1025 function anymore. */
1026 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1027 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1028 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1029 }
1030 }
1031
1032 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1033 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1034 been generated. */
1035
1036 void
1037 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1038 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1039 {
1040 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1041
1042 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1043 function. */
1044 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1045 current_function_funcdef_no);
1046 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1047 current_function_funcdef_no);
1048 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1049 }
1050
1051 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1052 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1053 been generated. */
1054
1055 void
1056 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1057 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1058 {
1059 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1060 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1061
1062 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1063 return;
1064
1065 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1066 function. */
1067 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1068 current_function_funcdef_no);
1069 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1070 current_function_funcdef_no);
1071 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1072 }
1073
1074 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1075 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1076 been generated. */
1077
1078 void
1079 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1080 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1081 {
1082 dw_fde_ref fde;
1083 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1084
1085 last_var_location_insn = NULL_RTX;
1086 cached_next_real_insn = NULL_RTX;
1087
1088 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1089 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1090
1091 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1092 function. */
1093 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1094 current_function_funcdef_no);
1095 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1096 fde = cfun->fde;
1097 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1098 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1099 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1100 }
1101
1102 void
1103 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1104 {
1105 /* Output call frame information. */
1106 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1107 output_call_frame_info (0);
1108
1109 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1110 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
1111 && targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
1112 output_call_frame_info (1);
1113 }
1114
1115 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1116
1117 static void
1118 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1119 {
1120 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1121 if (sec == text_section)
1122 text_section_used = true;
1123 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1124 cold_text_section_used = true;
1125 }
1126
1127 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1128 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1129
1130 void
1131 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1132 {
1133 section *sect;
1134 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1135
1136 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1137
1138 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1139 {
1140 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1141 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1142 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1143 }
1144 else
1145 {
1146 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1147 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1148 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1149 }
1150 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1151
1152 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1153 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1154 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1155
1156 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1157 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1158
1159 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1160 sect = current_function_section ();
1161 switch_to_section (sect);
1162
1163 fde->second_in_std_section
1164 = (sect == text_section
1165 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1166
1167 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1168 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1169
1170 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1171
1172 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1173 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1174 }
1175 \f
1176 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1177 for emitting location expressions. */
1178
1179 /* Data about a single source file. */
1180 struct GTY(()) dwarf_file_data {
1181 const char * filename;
1182 int emitted_number;
1183 };
1184
1185 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
1186 {
1187 tree variable;
1188 dw_die_ref die;
1189 } deferred_locations;
1190
1191 DEF_VEC_O(deferred_locations);
1192 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(deferred_locations,gc);
1193
1194 static GTY(()) VEC(deferred_locations, gc) *deferred_locations_list;
1195
1196 DEF_VEC_P(dw_die_ref);
1197 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_die_ref,heap);
1198
1199 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1200 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1201 their entire life. */
1202 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1203 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1204 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
1205 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
1206 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1207 Only on head of list */
1208 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1209 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1210 hashval_t hash;
1211 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1212 resolved. */
1213 bool resolved_addr;
1214 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1215 bool replaced;
1216 bool emitted;
1217 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1218 are the same. */
1219 bool force;
1220 } dw_loc_list_node;
1221
1222 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1223
1224 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1225
1226 static const char *
1227 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1228 {
1229 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1230
1231 if (name != NULL)
1232 return name;
1233
1234 return "OP_<unknown>";
1235 }
1236
1237 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1238 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1239 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1240
1241 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1242 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1243 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1244 {
1245 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_descr_node ();
1246
1247 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1248 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1249 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1250 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1251 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1252
1253 return descr;
1254 }
1255
1256 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1257 REG and OFFSET. */
1258
1259 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1260 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1261 {
1262 if (reg <= 31)
1263 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1264 offset, 0);
1265 else
1266 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
1267 }
1268
1269 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1270
1271 static inline void
1272 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1273 {
1274 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1275
1276 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1277 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1278 ;
1279
1280 *d = descr;
1281 }
1282
1283 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1284
1285 static bool
1286 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1287 {
1288 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1289 return false;
1290 switch (a->val_class)
1291 {
1292 case dw_val_class_none:
1293 return true;
1294 case dw_val_class_addr:
1295 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1296
1297 case dw_val_class_offset:
1298 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1299 case dw_val_class_const:
1300 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1301 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1302 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1303 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1304 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1305
1306 case dw_val_class_loc:
1307 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1308 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1309 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1310 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1311 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1312 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1313 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1314 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1315 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1316 case dw_val_class_str:
1317 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1318 case dw_val_class_flag:
1319 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1320 case dw_val_class_file:
1321 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1322 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1323 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1324
1325 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1326 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1327 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1328
1329 case dw_val_class_vec:
1330 {
1331 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1332 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1333
1334 return (a_len == b_len
1335 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1336 }
1337
1338 case dw_val_class_data8:
1339 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1340
1341 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1342 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1343 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1344 }
1345 gcc_unreachable ();
1346 }
1347
1348 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1349
1350 static bool
1351 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1352 {
1353 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1354 return false;
1355
1356 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1357 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1358 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1359 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1360 return false;
1361
1362 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1363 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1364 }
1365
1366 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1367
1368 bool
1369 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1370 {
1371 while (1)
1372 {
1373 if (a == b)
1374 return true;
1375 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1376 return false;
1377 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1378 return false;
1379
1380 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1381 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1382 }
1383 }
1384
1385
1386 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
1387
1388 static void
1389 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1390 {
1391 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1392 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1393
1394 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1395
1396 if (!offset)
1397 return;
1398
1399 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1400 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1401 ;
1402
1403 p = NULL;
1404 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1405 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1406 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1407 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1408 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1409
1410 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1411 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1412 if (p != NULL
1413 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1414 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1415 *p += offset;
1416
1417 else if (offset > 0)
1418 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1419
1420 else
1421 {
1422 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
1423 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1424 }
1425 }
1426
1427 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1428
1429 static void
1430 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1431 {
1432 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1433 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1434 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1435 }
1436
1437 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1438 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1439
1440 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1441
1442 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1443
1444 static unsigned long
1445 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1446 {
1447 unsigned long size = 1;
1448
1449 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1450 {
1451 case DW_OP_addr:
1452 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1453 break;
1454 case DW_OP_const1u:
1455 case DW_OP_const1s:
1456 size += 1;
1457 break;
1458 case DW_OP_const2u:
1459 case DW_OP_const2s:
1460 size += 2;
1461 break;
1462 case DW_OP_const4u:
1463 case DW_OP_const4s:
1464 size += 4;
1465 break;
1466 case DW_OP_const8u:
1467 case DW_OP_const8s:
1468 size += 8;
1469 break;
1470 case DW_OP_constu:
1471 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1472 break;
1473 case DW_OP_consts:
1474 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1475 break;
1476 case DW_OP_pick:
1477 size += 1;
1478 break;
1479 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1480 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1481 break;
1482 case DW_OP_skip:
1483 case DW_OP_bra:
1484 size += 2;
1485 break;
1486 case DW_OP_breg0:
1487 case DW_OP_breg1:
1488 case DW_OP_breg2:
1489 case DW_OP_breg3:
1490 case DW_OP_breg4:
1491 case DW_OP_breg5:
1492 case DW_OP_breg6:
1493 case DW_OP_breg7:
1494 case DW_OP_breg8:
1495 case DW_OP_breg9:
1496 case DW_OP_breg10:
1497 case DW_OP_breg11:
1498 case DW_OP_breg12:
1499 case DW_OP_breg13:
1500 case DW_OP_breg14:
1501 case DW_OP_breg15:
1502 case DW_OP_breg16:
1503 case DW_OP_breg17:
1504 case DW_OP_breg18:
1505 case DW_OP_breg19:
1506 case DW_OP_breg20:
1507 case DW_OP_breg21:
1508 case DW_OP_breg22:
1509 case DW_OP_breg23:
1510 case DW_OP_breg24:
1511 case DW_OP_breg25:
1512 case DW_OP_breg26:
1513 case DW_OP_breg27:
1514 case DW_OP_breg28:
1515 case DW_OP_breg29:
1516 case DW_OP_breg30:
1517 case DW_OP_breg31:
1518 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1519 break;
1520 case DW_OP_regx:
1521 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1522 break;
1523 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1524 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1525 break;
1526 case DW_OP_bregx:
1527 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1528 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1529 break;
1530 case DW_OP_piece:
1531 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1532 break;
1533 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1534 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1535 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1536 break;
1537 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1538 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1539 size += 1;
1540 break;
1541 case DW_OP_call2:
1542 size += 2;
1543 break;
1544 case DW_OP_call4:
1545 size += 4;
1546 break;
1547 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1548 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1549 break;
1550 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1551 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1552 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1553 break;
1554 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1555 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1556 break;
1557 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1558 {
1559 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1560 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1561 break;
1562 }
1563 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1564 {
1565 unsigned long o
1566 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1567 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1568 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1569 {
1570 case dw_val_class_vec:
1571 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1572 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1573 break;
1574 case dw_val_class_const:
1575 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1576 break;
1577 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1578 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1579 break;
1580 default:
1581 gcc_unreachable ();
1582 }
1583 break;
1584 }
1585 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1586 {
1587 unsigned long o
1588 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1589 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1590 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1591 }
1592 break;
1593 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1594 {
1595 unsigned long o
1596 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1597 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1598 }
1599 break;
1600 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1601 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1602 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1603 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1604 else
1605 {
1606 unsigned long o
1607 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1608 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1609 }
1610 break;
1611 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1612 size += 4;
1613 break;
1614 default:
1615 break;
1616 }
1617
1618 return size;
1619 }
1620
1621 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1622
1623 unsigned long
1624 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1625 {
1626 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1627 unsigned long size;
1628
1629 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1630 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1631 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1632 {
1633 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1634 break;
1635 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1636 }
1637 if (! l)
1638 return size;
1639
1640 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1641 {
1642 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1643 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1644 }
1645
1646 return size;
1647 }
1648
1649 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1650 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1651 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1652
1653 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1654 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1655 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1656 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1657 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1658 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1659
1660 static void
1661 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1662 {
1663 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1664 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1665
1666 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1667 {
1668 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1669 case DW_OP_const2u:
1670 case DW_OP_const2s:
1671 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1672 break;
1673 case DW_OP_const4u:
1674 if (loc->dtprel)
1675 {
1676 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1677 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
1678 val1->v.val_addr);
1679 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1680 break;
1681 }
1682 /* FALLTHRU */
1683 case DW_OP_const4s:
1684 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1685 break;
1686 case DW_OP_const8u:
1687 if (loc->dtprel)
1688 {
1689 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1690 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
1691 val1->v.val_addr);
1692 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1693 break;
1694 }
1695 /* FALLTHRU */
1696 case DW_OP_const8s:
1697 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
1698 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1699 break;
1700 case DW_OP_skip:
1701 case DW_OP_bra:
1702 {
1703 int offset;
1704
1705 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
1706 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
1707
1708 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
1709 }
1710 break;
1711 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1712 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1713 switch (val2->val_class)
1714 {
1715 case dw_val_class_const:
1716 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1717 break;
1718 case dw_val_class_vec:
1719 {
1720 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
1721 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
1722 unsigned int i;
1723 unsigned char *p;
1724
1725 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
1726 {
1727 elt_size /= 2;
1728 len *= 2;
1729 }
1730 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
1731 i < len;
1732 i++, p += elt_size)
1733 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
1734 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
1735 }
1736 break;
1737 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1738 {
1739 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
1740
1741 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1742 {
1743 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
1744 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
1745 }
1746 else
1747 {
1748 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
1749 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
1750 }
1751 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1752 first, NULL);
1753 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1754 second, NULL);
1755 }
1756 break;
1757 case dw_val_class_addr:
1758 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
1759 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
1760 break;
1761 default:
1762 gcc_unreachable ();
1763 }
1764 break;
1765 #else
1766 case DW_OP_const2u:
1767 case DW_OP_const2s:
1768 case DW_OP_const4u:
1769 case DW_OP_const4s:
1770 case DW_OP_const8u:
1771 case DW_OP_const8s:
1772 case DW_OP_skip:
1773 case DW_OP_bra:
1774 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1775 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
1776 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
1777 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
1778 only doing unwinding. */
1779 gcc_unreachable ();
1780 #endif
1781 case DW_OP_const1u:
1782 case DW_OP_const1s:
1783 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1784 break;
1785 case DW_OP_constu:
1786 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1787 break;
1788 case DW_OP_consts:
1789 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1790 break;
1791 case DW_OP_pick:
1792 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1793 break;
1794 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1795 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1796 break;
1797 case DW_OP_breg0:
1798 case DW_OP_breg1:
1799 case DW_OP_breg2:
1800 case DW_OP_breg3:
1801 case DW_OP_breg4:
1802 case DW_OP_breg5:
1803 case DW_OP_breg6:
1804 case DW_OP_breg7:
1805 case DW_OP_breg8:
1806 case DW_OP_breg9:
1807 case DW_OP_breg10:
1808 case DW_OP_breg11:
1809 case DW_OP_breg12:
1810 case DW_OP_breg13:
1811 case DW_OP_breg14:
1812 case DW_OP_breg15:
1813 case DW_OP_breg16:
1814 case DW_OP_breg17:
1815 case DW_OP_breg18:
1816 case DW_OP_breg19:
1817 case DW_OP_breg20:
1818 case DW_OP_breg21:
1819 case DW_OP_breg22:
1820 case DW_OP_breg23:
1821 case DW_OP_breg24:
1822 case DW_OP_breg25:
1823 case DW_OP_breg26:
1824 case DW_OP_breg27:
1825 case DW_OP_breg28:
1826 case DW_OP_breg29:
1827 case DW_OP_breg30:
1828 case DW_OP_breg31:
1829 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1830 break;
1831 case DW_OP_regx:
1832 {
1833 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1834 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1835 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1836 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1837 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1838 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1839 }
1840 break;
1841 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1842 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1843 break;
1844 case DW_OP_bregx:
1845 {
1846 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1847 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1848 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1849 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1850 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1851 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1852 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1853 }
1854 break;
1855 case DW_OP_piece:
1856 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1857 break;
1858 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1859 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1860 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1861 break;
1862 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1863 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1864 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1865 break;
1866
1867 case DW_OP_addr:
1868 if (loc->dtprel)
1869 {
1870 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
1871 {
1872 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
1873 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
1874 val1->v.val_addr);
1875 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1876 }
1877 else
1878 gcc_unreachable ();
1879 }
1880 else
1881 {
1882 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1883 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
1884 #else
1885 gcc_unreachable ();
1886 #endif
1887 }
1888 break;
1889
1890 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1891 {
1892 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
1893 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
1894 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
1895 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
1896 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
1897 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1898 }
1899 break;
1900
1901 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1902 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
1903 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
1904 break;
1905
1906 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1907 {
1908 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
1909 gcc_assert (o);
1910 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
1911 switch (val2->val_class)
1912 {
1913 case dw_val_class_const:
1914 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
1915 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
1916 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1917 break;
1918 case dw_val_class_vec:
1919 {
1920 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
1921 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
1922 unsigned int i;
1923 unsigned char *p;
1924
1925 l = len * elt_size;
1926 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
1927 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
1928 {
1929 elt_size /= 2;
1930 len *= 2;
1931 }
1932 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
1933 i < len;
1934 i++, p += elt_size)
1935 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
1936 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
1937 }
1938 break;
1939 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1940 {
1941 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
1942 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
1943
1944 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
1945 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1946 {
1947 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
1948 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
1949 }
1950 else
1951 {
1952 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
1953 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
1954 }
1955 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
1956 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
1957 }
1958 break;
1959 default:
1960 gcc_unreachable ();
1961 }
1962 }
1963 break;
1964 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1965 {
1966 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1967 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
1968 gcc_assert (o);
1969 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1970 {
1971 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1972 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1973 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1974 }
1975 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1976 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
1977 }
1978 break;
1979 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1980 {
1981 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
1982 gcc_assert (o);
1983 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1984 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
1985 }
1986 break;
1987 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1988 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1989 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1990 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1991 else
1992 {
1993 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
1994 gcc_assert (o);
1995 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
1996 }
1997 break;
1998
1999 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2000 {
2001 unsigned long o;
2002 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2003 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2004 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2005 }
2006 break;
2007
2008 default:
2009 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2010 break;
2011 }
2012 }
2013
2014 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2015 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2016 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2017 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2018 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2019 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2020
2021 void
2022 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2023 {
2024 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2025 {
2026 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2027 /* Output the opcode. */
2028 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2029 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2030 {
2031 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2032 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2033 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2034 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2035 }
2036 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2037 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2038 {
2039 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2040 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2041 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2042 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2043 }
2044
2045 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2046 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2047
2048 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2049 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2050 }
2051 }
2052
2053 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2054 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2055
2056 static void
2057 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2058 {
2059 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2060 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2061
2062 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2063 {
2064 case DW_OP_addr:
2065 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2066 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2067 gcc_unreachable ();
2068
2069 case DW_OP_const1u:
2070 case DW_OP_const1s:
2071 case DW_OP_pick:
2072 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2073 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2074 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2075 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2076 break;
2077
2078 case DW_OP_const2u:
2079 case DW_OP_const2s:
2080 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2081 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2082 break;
2083
2084 case DW_OP_const4u:
2085 case DW_OP_const4s:
2086 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2087 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2088 break;
2089
2090 case DW_OP_const8u:
2091 case DW_OP_const8s:
2092 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2093 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2094 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2095 break;
2096
2097 case DW_OP_skip:
2098 case DW_OP_bra:
2099 {
2100 int offset;
2101
2102 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2103 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2104
2105 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2106 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2107 }
2108 break;
2109
2110 case DW_OP_regx:
2111 {
2112 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2113 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2114 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2115 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2116 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2117 }
2118 break;
2119
2120 case DW_OP_constu:
2121 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2122 case DW_OP_piece:
2123 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2124 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2125 break;
2126
2127 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2128 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2129 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2130 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2131 break;
2132
2133 case DW_OP_consts:
2134 case DW_OP_breg0:
2135 case DW_OP_breg1:
2136 case DW_OP_breg2:
2137 case DW_OP_breg3:
2138 case DW_OP_breg4:
2139 case DW_OP_breg5:
2140 case DW_OP_breg6:
2141 case DW_OP_breg7:
2142 case DW_OP_breg8:
2143 case DW_OP_breg9:
2144 case DW_OP_breg10:
2145 case DW_OP_breg11:
2146 case DW_OP_breg12:
2147 case DW_OP_breg13:
2148 case DW_OP_breg14:
2149 case DW_OP_breg15:
2150 case DW_OP_breg16:
2151 case DW_OP_breg17:
2152 case DW_OP_breg18:
2153 case DW_OP_breg19:
2154 case DW_OP_breg20:
2155 case DW_OP_breg21:
2156 case DW_OP_breg22:
2157 case DW_OP_breg23:
2158 case DW_OP_breg24:
2159 case DW_OP_breg25:
2160 case DW_OP_breg26:
2161 case DW_OP_breg27:
2162 case DW_OP_breg28:
2163 case DW_OP_breg29:
2164 case DW_OP_breg30:
2165 case DW_OP_breg31:
2166 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2167 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2168 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2169 break;
2170
2171 case DW_OP_bregx:
2172 {
2173 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2174 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2175 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2176 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2177 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2178 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2179 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2180 }
2181 break;
2182
2183 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2184 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2185 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2186 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2187 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2188 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2189 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2190 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2191 gcc_unreachable ();
2192 break;
2193
2194 default:
2195 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2196 break;
2197 }
2198 }
2199
2200 void
2201 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2202 {
2203 while (1)
2204 {
2205 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2206 /* Output the opcode. */
2207 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2208 {
2209 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2210 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2211 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2212 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2213 }
2214 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2215 {
2216 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2217 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2218 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2219 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2220 }
2221 /* Output the opcode. */
2222 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2223 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2224
2225 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2226 break;
2227 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2228
2229 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2230 }
2231 }
2232
2233 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2234 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2235 expression. */
2236
2237 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
2238 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
2239 {
2240 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
2241
2242 offset += cfa->offset;
2243
2244 if (cfa->indirect)
2245 {
2246 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2247 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2248 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2249 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2250 if (offset != 0)
2251 {
2252 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
2253 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2254 }
2255 }
2256 else
2257 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2258
2259 return head;
2260 }
2261
2262 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2263 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2264 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2265
2266 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
2267 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2268 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2269 {
2270 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head;
2271 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2272 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2273
2274 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2275 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2276 {
2277 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2278 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2279 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2280 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2281 }
2282 else
2283 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2284 return head;
2285 }
2286 \f
2287 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2288
2289 /* .debug_str support. */
2290 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
2291
2292 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2293 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2294 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2295 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2296 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2297 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2298 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2299 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2300 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2301 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2302 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2303 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
2304 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2305 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
2306 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2307 dw_die_ref);
2308 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2309 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
2310 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2311 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2312
2313 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2314
2315 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2316 {
2317 dwarf2out_init,
2318 dwarf2out_finish,
2319 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2320 dwarf2out_define,
2321 dwarf2out_undef,
2322 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2323 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2324 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2325 dwarf2out_end_block,
2326 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2327 dwarf2out_source_line,
2328 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2329 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2330 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2331 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2332 #else
2333 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2334 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2335 #endif
2336 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2337 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2338 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2339 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2340 dwarf2out_global_decl,
2341 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2342 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2343 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2344 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2345 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2346 something tries to reference them. */
2347 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2348 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
2349 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2350 dwarf2out_var_location,
2351 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2352 dwarf2out_set_name,
2353 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2354 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2355 };
2356 \f
2357 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2358 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2359 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2360
2361 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2362 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2363 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2364 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2365
2366 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2367 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2368 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2369 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2370 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2371 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2372 yet. */
2373
2374 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2375
2376 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2377 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2378
2379 typedef long int dw_offset;
2380
2381 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
2382
2383 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
2384 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
2385 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
2386 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
2387 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
2388 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
2389
2390 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2391 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2392 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2393 supported. */
2394
2395 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2396 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2397 LI_set_address,
2398
2399 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2400 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2401 special opcodes. */
2402 LI_set_line,
2403
2404 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2405 LI_set_file,
2406
2407 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2408 LI_set_column,
2409
2410 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2411 LI_negate_stmt,
2412
2413 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2414 LI_set_prologue_end,
2415 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2416
2417 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2418 LI_set_discriminator
2419 };
2420
2421 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2422 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2423 unsigned int val;
2424 } dw_line_info_entry;
2425
2426 DEF_VEC_O(dw_line_info_entry);
2427 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_line_info_entry, gc);
2428
2429 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table_struct {
2430 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2431 const char *end_label;
2432
2433 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2434 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2435 unsigned int file_num;
2436 unsigned int line_num;
2437 unsigned int column_num;
2438 int discrim_num;
2439 bool is_stmt;
2440 bool in_use;
2441
2442 VEC(dw_line_info_entry, gc) *entries;
2443 } dw_line_info_table;
2444
2445 typedef dw_line_info_table *dw_line_info_table_p;
2446
2447 DEF_VEC_P(dw_line_info_table_p);
2448 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_line_info_table_p, gc);
2449
2450 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2451 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2452 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2453
2454 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2455 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2456 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2457 }
2458 dw_attr_node;
2459
2460 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
2461 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
2462
2463 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2464 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2465 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2466
2467 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"))) die_struct {
2468 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2469 {
2470 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2471 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2472 }
2473 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2474 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
2475 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2476 dw_die_ref die_child;
2477 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2478 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2479 dw_offset die_offset;
2480 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2481 int die_mark;
2482 unsigned int decl_id;
2483 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2484 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2485 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2486 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2487 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2488 }
2489 die_node;
2490
2491 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2492 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2493 c = die->die_child; \
2494 if (c) do { \
2495 c = c->die_sib; \
2496 expr; \
2497 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2498 } while (0)
2499
2500 /* The pubname structure */
2501
2502 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2503 dw_die_ref die;
2504 const char *name;
2505 }
2506 pubname_entry;
2507
2508 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
2509 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
2510
2511 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
2512 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2513 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2514 int num;
2515 };
2516
2517 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2518
2519 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2520 unsigned char code;
2521 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2522 const char *info;
2523 }
2524 macinfo_entry;
2525
2526 DEF_VEC_O(macinfo_entry);
2527 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(macinfo_entry, gc);
2528
2529 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
2530 const char *begin;
2531 const char *end;
2532 };
2533
2534 /* The comdat type node structure. */
2535 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
2536 {
2537 dw_die_ref root_die;
2538 dw_die_ref type_die;
2539 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
2540 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
2541 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
2542 }
2543 comdat_type_node;
2544
2545 /* The limbo die list structure. */
2546 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
2547 dw_die_ref die;
2548 tree created_for;
2549 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
2550 }
2551 limbo_die_node;
2552
2553 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
2554 {
2555 dw_die_ref old_die;
2556 dw_die_ref new_die;
2557 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
2558 }
2559 skeleton_chain_node;
2560
2561 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
2562 implicitly generated for a type.
2563
2564 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
2565 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
2566 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
2567 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
2568 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
2569 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
2570 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
2571
2572 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
2573 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
2574 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
2575 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
2576 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
2577 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
2578 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
2579 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
2580 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
2581
2582 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
2583 language, and compiler version. */
2584
2585 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
2586 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2587 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
2588
2589 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
2590 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2591 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
2592 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
2593
2594 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
2595 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
2596
2597 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
2598 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
2599 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2600 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2601 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
2602
2603 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
2604 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
2605 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
2606 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2607 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2608 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
2609
2610 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
2611 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
2612 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
2613 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
2614 #else
2615 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
2616 #endif
2617 #endif
2618
2619 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
2620 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
2621 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
2622
2623 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
2624 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
2625
2626 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
2627 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
2628
2629 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
2630 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
2631 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
2632 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
2633 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
2634
2635 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
2636 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
2637 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
2638 #endif
2639
2640 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
2641 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
2642 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
2643
2644 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
2645 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
2646
2647 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
2648 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
2649
2650 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
2651 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
2652
2653 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
2654 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
2655 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
2656
2657 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
2658 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
2659
2660 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
2661 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
2662 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
2663
2664 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
2665 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
2666 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t common_block_die_table;
2667
2668 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
2669 dw_die_ref die;
2670 tree arg;
2671 } die_arg_entry;
2672
2673 DEF_VEC_O(die_arg_entry);
2674 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(die_arg_entry,gc);
2675
2676 /* Node of the variable location list. */
2677 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
2678 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
2679 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
2680 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
2681 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
2682 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
2683 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
2684 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
2685 NULL as second operand. */
2686 rtx GTY (()) loc;
2687 const char * GTY (()) label;
2688 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2689 };
2690
2691 /* Variable location list. */
2692 struct GTY (()) var_loc_list_def {
2693 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
2694
2695 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
2696 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
2697 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
2698 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
2699 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
2700 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
2701 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
2702
2703 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
2704 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
2705 is after section switch. */
2706 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
2707
2708 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
2709 unsigned int decl_id;
2710 };
2711 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
2712
2713 /* Call argument location list. */
2714 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
2715 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
2716 const char * GTY (()) label;
2717 tree GTY (()) block;
2718 bool tail_call_p;
2719 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
2720 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2721 };
2722
2723
2724 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
2725 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
2726
2727 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
2728 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
2729 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
2730
2731 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
2732 static int call_site_count = -1;
2733 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
2734 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
2735
2736 /* Vector mapping block numbers to DW_TAG_{lexical_block,inlined_subroutine}
2737 DIEs. */
2738 static VEC (dw_die_ref, heap) *block_map;
2739
2740 /* A cached location list. */
2741 struct GTY (()) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
2742 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
2743 unsigned int decl_id;
2744
2745 /* The cached location list. */
2746 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
2747 };
2748 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
2749
2750 /* Table of cached location lists. */
2751 static GTY ((param_is (cached_dw_loc_list))) htab_t cached_dw_loc_list_table;
2752
2753 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
2754 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
2755 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
2756 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
2757 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
2758
2759 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
2760 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
2761
2762 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
2763 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
2764
2765 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
2766 abbrev_die_table. */
2767 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
2768
2769 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
2770 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
2771
2772 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
2773 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
2774 assembly for the function. */
2775 static dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
2776
2777 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
2778 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
2779 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
2780
2781 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
2782 static GTY(()) VEC (dw_line_info_table_p, gc) *separate_line_info;
2783
2784 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
2785 refer to. */
2786 static bool info_section_emitted;
2787
2788 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
2789 accessible names. */
2790 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
2791
2792 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
2793 accessible types. */
2794 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
2795
2796 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
2797 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
2798 static GTY (()) VEC (macinfo_entry, gc) * macinfo_table;
2799
2800 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
2801 emitted. */
2802 #define have_macinfo \
2803 (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
2804 && !VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table))
2805
2806 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
2807 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
2808
2809 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
2810 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
2811
2812 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
2813 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
2814
2815 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
2816 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
2817 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
2818
2819 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
2820 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
2821
2822 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
2823 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
2824
2825 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
2826 ranges_table. */
2827 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
2828
2829 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
2830 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
2831
2832 /* Unique label counter. */
2833 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
2834
2835 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
2836 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
2837
2838 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
2839 static int current_function_has_inlines;
2840
2841 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
2842 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
2843
2844 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
2845 static GTY(()) int label_num;
2846
2847 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
2848 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
2849
2850 static GTY(()) VEC(die_arg_entry,gc) *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
2851
2852 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
2853 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
2854 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
2855 we do it at the end of compilation. */
2856 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *generic_type_instances;
2857
2858 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
2859 within the current function. */
2860 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
2861 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
2862
2863 static VEC (dw_die_ref, heap) *base_types;
2864
2865 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
2866
2867 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
2868 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
2869 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
2870 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
2871 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
2872 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
2873 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
2874 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
2875 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
2876 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
2877 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
2878 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
2879 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
2880 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
2881 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2882 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
2883 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
2884 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2885 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
2886 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
2887 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
2888 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
2889 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
2890 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
2891 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
2892 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
2893 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
2894 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
2895 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
2896 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
2897 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
2898 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
2899 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2900 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
2901 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
2902 dw_loc_list_ref);
2903 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
2904 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
2905 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
2906 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
2907 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
2908 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
2909 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
2910 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2911 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
2912 unsigned long);
2913 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
2914 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
2915 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
2916 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
2917 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
2918 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
2919 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
2920 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
2921 static bool is_cxx (void);
2922 static bool is_fortran (void);
2923 static bool is_ada (void);
2924 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
2925 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
2926 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
2927 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
2928 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
2929 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
2930 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
2931 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
2932 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
2933 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
2934 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
2935 static hashval_t common_block_die_table_hash (const void *);
2936 static int common_block_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
2937 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
2938 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
2939 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
2940 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
2941 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
2942 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
2943 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
2944 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
2945 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
2946 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
2947 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
2948 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
2949 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
2950 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
2951 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
2952 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
2953 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
2954 struct checksum_attributes;
2955 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
2956 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
2957 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
2958 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
2959 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
2960 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
2961 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
2962 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
2963 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
2964 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
2965 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
2966 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
2967 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
2968 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
2969 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
2970 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
2971 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
2972 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
2973 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
2974 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
2975 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
2976 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
2977 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
2978 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
2979 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
2980 dw_die_ref,
2981 dw_die_ref);
2982 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
2983 static dw_die_ref copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
2984 static void copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
2985 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
2986
2987 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
2988 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
2989 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
2990 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
2991 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
2992 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
2993 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref, htab_t);
2994 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
2995 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2996 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
2997 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
2998 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
2999 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3000 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3001 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3002 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
3003 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3004 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3005 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3006 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3007 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
3008 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3009 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
3010 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
3011 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3012 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3013 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3014 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3015 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3016 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3017 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
3018 static void output_aranges (unsigned long);
3019 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
3020 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
3021 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3022 bool *);
3023 static void output_ranges (void);
3024 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3025 static void output_line_info (void);
3026 static void output_file_names (void);
3027 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
3028 static int is_base_type (tree);
3029 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3030 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
3031 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3032 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3033 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3034 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3035 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3036 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3037 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3038 enum var_init_status);
3039 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3040 enum var_init_status);
3041 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
3042 enum var_init_status);
3043 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3044 static int resolve_one_addr (rtx *, void *);
3045 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3046 enum var_init_status);
3047 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
3048 enum var_init_status);
3049 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int);
3050 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
3051 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3052 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3053 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3054 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3055 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3056 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
3057 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3058 dw_loc_list_ref);
3059 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3060 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3061 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3062 static void insert_double (double_int, unsigned char *);
3063 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3064 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3065 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool,
3066 enum dwarf_attribute);
3067 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3068 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3069 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3070 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3071 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3072 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
3073 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3074 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3075 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3076 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3077 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3078 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3079 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3080 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3081 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3082 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3083 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3084 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3085 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3086 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3087 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3088 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
3089 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3090 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3091 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3092 #if 0
3093 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3094 #endif
3095 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3096 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3097 #if 0
3098 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3099 #endif
3100 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3101 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3102 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3103 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3104 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3105 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3106 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3107 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3108 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3109 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3110 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3111 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3112 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3113 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3114 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3115 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3116 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3117 enum debug_info_usage);
3118 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3119 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3120 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3121 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3122 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3123 static inline int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
3124 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3125 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3126 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3127 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3128 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3129 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3130 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3131 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3132 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3133 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3134 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3135 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3136 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3137 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3138 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3139 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3140 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3141 const char *, const char *);
3142 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3143 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3144 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3145
3146 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3147 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3148 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3149 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3150 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3151 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3152 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3153 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3154 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref);
3155 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref);
3156 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3157 const char *, const char *);
3158 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3159 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3160 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3161 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3162 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3163
3164 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3165 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3166 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3167 #endif
3168 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3169 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3170 #endif
3171 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3172 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3173 #endif
3174 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3175 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3176 #endif
3177 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3178 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3179 #endif
3180 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3181 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3182 #endif
3183 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3184 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3185 #endif
3186 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3187 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
3188 #endif
3189 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3190 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION ".debug_pubtypes"
3191 #endif
3192 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3193 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3194 #endif
3195 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3196 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3197 #endif
3198
3199 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3200 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3201 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3202 #endif
3203
3204 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3205 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3206 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3207 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3208 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3209
3210 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3211 the section names themselves. */
3212
3213 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3214 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3215 #endif
3216 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3217 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3218 #endif
3219 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3220 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3221 #endif
3222 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3223 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3224 #endif
3225 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3226 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3227 #endif
3228 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3229 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3230 #endif
3231 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3232 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3233 #endif
3234 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3235 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3236 #endif
3237 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3238 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3239 #endif
3240
3241
3242 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3243 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3244 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3245 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3246 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3247
3248 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3249 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3250 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3251 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3252 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3253 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3254 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3255 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3256 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3257 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3258
3259 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3260 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3261 #endif
3262 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3263 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3264 #endif
3265 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3266 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3267 #endif
3268 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3269 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3270 #endif
3271 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3272 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3273 #endif
3274
3275 \f
3276 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3277 static dw_die_ref
3278 comp_unit_die (void)
3279 {
3280 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3281 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3282 return single_comp_unit_die;
3283 }
3284
3285 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3286 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3287
3288 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3289
3290 void
3291 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3292 {
3293 demangle_name_func = func;
3294 }
3295
3296 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3297
3298 static inline int
3299 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3300 {
3301 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3302 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3303 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3304 }
3305
3306 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3307 removed. */
3308
3309 static inline tree
3310 type_main_variant (tree type)
3311 {
3312 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3313
3314 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3315 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3316 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3317 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3318 here. */
3319 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3320 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3321 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3322
3323 return type;
3324 }
3325
3326 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3327
3328 static inline int
3329 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
3330 {
3331 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3332
3333 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3334 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3335 }
3336
3337 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
3338
3339 static void
3340 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
3341 {
3342 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
3343 }
3344
3345 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
3346
3347 static unsigned long int
3348 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3349 {
3350 if (ref->die_offset)
3351 return ref->die_offset;
3352 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
3353 {
3354 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
3355 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3356 }
3357 return ref->die_offset;
3358 }
3359
3360 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
3361
3362 static unsigned long int
3363 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3364 {
3365 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3366 return ref->die_offset;
3367 }
3368
3369 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3370
3371 static const char *
3372 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
3373 {
3374 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
3375
3376 if (name != NULL)
3377 return name;
3378
3379 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
3380 }
3381
3382 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
3383
3384 static const char *
3385 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
3386 {
3387 const char *name;
3388
3389 switch (attr)
3390 {
3391 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3392 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
3393 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
3394 #else
3395 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
3396 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
3397 #endif
3398
3399 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3400 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
3401 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
3402 #else
3403 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
3404 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
3405 #endif
3406 }
3407
3408 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
3409
3410 if (name != NULL)
3411 return name;
3412
3413 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
3414 }
3415
3416 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
3417
3418 static const char *
3419 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
3420 {
3421 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
3422
3423 if (name != NULL)
3424 return name;
3425
3426 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
3427 }
3428 \f
3429 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
3430 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
3431 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
3432 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
3433 given block. */
3434
3435 static tree
3436 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
3437 {
3438 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
3439 return NULL_TREE;
3440
3441 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
3442 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
3443 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
3444 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
3445 return NULL_TREE;
3446
3447 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
3448 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
3449 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
3450
3451 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
3452 }
3453
3454 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
3455 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
3456 parameter. */
3457
3458 static tree
3459 decl_class_context (tree decl)
3460 {
3461 tree context = NULL_TREE;
3462
3463 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
3464 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
3465 else
3466 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
3467 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
3468
3469 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
3470 context = NULL_TREE;
3471
3472 return context;
3473 }
3474 \f
3475 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
3476
3477 static inline void
3478 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
3479 {
3480 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
3481 if (die == NULL)
3482 return;
3483
3484 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
3485 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
3486 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
3487 }
3488
3489 static inline enum dw_val_class
3490 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
3491 {
3492 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
3493 }
3494
3495 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
3496
3497 static inline void
3498 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
3499 {
3500 dw_attr_node attr;
3501
3502 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3503 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
3504 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
3505 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3506 }
3507
3508 static inline unsigned
3509 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
3510 {
3511 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
3512 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
3513 }
3514
3515 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3516
3517 static inline void
3518 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
3519 {
3520 dw_attr_node attr;
3521
3522 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3523 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3524 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
3525 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3526 }
3527
3528 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
3529 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
3530 {
3531 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
3532 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
3533 }
3534
3535 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3536
3537 static inline void
3538 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3539 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
3540 {
3541 dw_attr_node attr;
3542
3543 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3544 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3545 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
3546 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3547 }
3548
3549 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
3550 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
3551 {
3552 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
3553 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
3554 }
3555
3556 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3557
3558 static inline void
3559 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3560 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
3561 {
3562 dw_attr_node attr;
3563
3564 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3565 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
3566 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
3567 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
3568 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3569 }
3570
3571 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
3572
3573 static inline void
3574 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3575 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
3576 {
3577 dw_attr_node attr;
3578
3579 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3580 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
3581 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
3582 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
3583 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
3584 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3585 }
3586
3587 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
3588
3589 static inline void
3590 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3591 unsigned char data8[8])
3592 {
3593 dw_attr_node attr;
3594
3595 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3596 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
3597 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
3598 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3599 }
3600
3601 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
3602
3603 static hashval_t
3604 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
3605 {
3606 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
3607 }
3608
3609 static int
3610 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
3611 {
3612 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
3613 (const char *)x2) == 0;
3614 }
3615
3616 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
3617
3618 static struct indirect_string_node *
3619 find_AT_string (const char *str)
3620 {
3621 struct indirect_string_node *node;
3622 void **slot;
3623
3624 if (! debug_str_hash)
3625 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
3626 debug_str_eq, NULL);
3627
3628 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
3629 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
3630 if (*slot == NULL)
3631 {
3632 node = ggc_alloc_cleared_indirect_string_node ();
3633 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
3634 *slot = node;
3635 }
3636 else
3637 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
3638
3639 node->refcount++;
3640 return node;
3641 }
3642
3643 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
3644
3645 static inline void
3646 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
3647 {
3648 dw_attr_node attr;
3649 struct indirect_string_node *node;
3650
3651 node = find_AT_string (str);
3652
3653 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3654 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
3655 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
3656 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3657 }
3658
3659 static inline const char *
3660 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
3661 {
3662 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
3663 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
3667 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
3668
3669 static enum dwarf_form
3670 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
3671 {
3672 struct indirect_string_node *node;
3673 unsigned int len;
3674 char label[32];
3675
3676 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
3677
3678 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
3679 if (node->form)
3680 return node->form;
3681
3682 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
3683
3684 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
3685 always better to put it inline. */
3686 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
3687 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
3688
3689 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
3690 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
3691 single module. */
3692 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
3693 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
3694 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
3695 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
3696
3697 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
3698 ++dw2_string_counter;
3699 node->label = xstrdup (label);
3700
3701 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
3702 }
3703
3704 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
3705
3706 static inline void
3707 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
3708 {
3709 dw_attr_node attr;
3710
3711 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
3712 gcc_assert (targ_die != NULL);
3713 #else
3714 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
3715 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
3716 if (targ_die == NULL)
3717 return;
3718 #endif
3719
3720 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3721 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
3722 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
3723 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
3724 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3725 }
3726
3727 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
3728
3729 static inline void
3730 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_ref ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
3731 {
3732 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
3733 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
3734 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
3735 }
3736
3737 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
3738 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
3739
3740 static inline void
3741 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
3742 {
3743 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
3744 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
3745 targ_die->die_definition = die;
3746 }
3747
3748 static inline dw_die_ref
3749 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
3750 {
3751 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
3752 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
3753 }
3754
3755 static inline int
3756 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
3757 {
3758 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
3759 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
3760
3761 return 0;
3762 }
3763
3764 static inline void
3765 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
3766 {
3767 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
3768 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
3769 }
3770
3771 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
3772
3773 static inline void
3774 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
3775 {
3776 dw_attr_node attr;
3777
3778 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3779 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
3780 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
3781 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3782 }
3783
3784 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
3785
3786 static inline void
3787 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3788 {
3789 dw_attr_node attr;
3790
3791 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3792 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
3793 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
3794 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3795 }
3796
3797 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3798 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
3799 {
3800 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
3801 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
3802 }
3803
3804 static inline void
3805 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
3806 {
3807 dw_attr_node attr;
3808
3809 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3810 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
3811 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
3812 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3813 have_location_lists = true;
3814 }
3815
3816 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
3817 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
3818 {
3819 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
3820 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
3821 }
3822
3823 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
3824 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_ref a)
3825 {
3826 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
3827 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
3828 }
3829
3830 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
3831
3832 static inline void
3833 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
3834 {
3835 dw_attr_node attr;
3836
3837 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3838 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3839 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
3840 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3841 }
3842
3843 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
3844
3845 static inline rtx
3846 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
3847 {
3848 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
3849 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
3850 }
3851
3852 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
3853
3854 static inline void
3855 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3856 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
3857 {
3858 dw_attr_node attr;
3859
3860 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3861 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
3862 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
3863 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3864 }
3865
3866 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
3867
3868 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
3869 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
3870 {
3871 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
3872 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
3873 }
3874
3875 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
3876
3877 static inline void
3878 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3879 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
3880 {
3881 dw_attr_node attr;
3882
3883 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3884 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
3885 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
3886 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
3887 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3888 }
3889
3890 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
3891
3892 static inline void
3893 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
3894 {
3895 dw_attr_node attr;
3896
3897 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3898 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
3899 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
3900 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3901 }
3902
3903 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
3904 debug_line section. */
3905
3906 static inline void
3907 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3908 const char *label)
3909 {
3910 dw_attr_node attr;
3911
3912 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3913 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
3914 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
3915 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3916 }
3917
3918 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
3919 debug_macinfo section. */
3920
3921 static inline void
3922 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3923 const char *label)
3924 {
3925 dw_attr_node attr;
3926
3927 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3928 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
3929 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
3930 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3931 }
3932
3933 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
3934
3935 static inline void
3936 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3937 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3938 {
3939 dw_attr_node attr;
3940
3941 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3942 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
3943 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
3944 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3945 }
3946
3947 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
3948
3949 static void
3950 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3951 long unsigned int offset)
3952 {
3953 dw_attr_node attr;
3954
3955 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3956 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
3957 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
3958 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3959 }
3960
3961 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
3962
3963 static inline const char *
3964 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref a)
3965 {
3966 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
3967 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
3968 }
3969
3970 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
3971
3972 static inline const char *
3973 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref a)
3974 {
3975 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
3976 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
3977 }
3978
3979 static inline const char *
3980 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
3981 {
3982 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
3983 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
3984 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
3985 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
3986 }
3987
3988 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
3989
3990 static dw_attr_ref
3991 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
3992 {
3993 dw_attr_ref a;
3994 unsigned ix;
3995 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
3996
3997 if (! die)
3998 return NULL;
3999
4000 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
4001 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4002 return a;
4003 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4004 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4005 spec = AT_ref (a);
4006
4007 if (spec)
4008 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4009
4010 return NULL;
4011 }
4012
4013 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
4014
4015 static dw_die_ref
4016 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
4017 {
4018 dw_die_ref t;
4019
4020 if (!die)
4021 return NULL;
4022
4023 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
4024 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
4025 die = t;
4026
4027 return die->die_parent;
4028 }
4029
4030 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4031 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4032 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4033
4034 static inline const char *
4035 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4036 {
4037 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4038
4039 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4040 }
4041
4042 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4043 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4044 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4045
4046 static inline const char *
4047 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4048 {
4049 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4050
4051 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4052 }
4053
4054 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4055 NULL if it is not present. */
4056
4057 static inline const char *
4058 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4059 {
4060 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4061
4062 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4063 }
4064
4065 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4066 if it is not present. */
4067
4068 static inline int
4069 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4070 {
4071 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4072
4073 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4074 }
4075
4076 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4077 if it is not present. */
4078
4079 static inline unsigned
4080 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4081 {
4082 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4083
4084 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4085 }
4086
4087 static inline dw_die_ref
4088 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4089 {
4090 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4091
4092 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4093 }
4094
4095 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4096 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4097 {
4098 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4099
4100 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
4101 }
4102
4103 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
4104
4105 static inline bool
4106 is_cxx (void)
4107 {
4108 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4109
4110 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
4111 }
4112
4113 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
4114
4115 static inline bool
4116 is_fortran (void)
4117 {
4118 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4119
4120 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
4121 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
4122 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
4123 }
4124
4125 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
4126
4127 static inline bool
4128 is_ada (void)
4129 {
4130 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4131
4132 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
4133 }
4134
4135 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
4136
4137 static void
4138 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4139 {
4140 dw_attr_ref a;
4141 unsigned ix;
4142
4143 if (! die)
4144 return;
4145
4146 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
4147 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4148 {
4149 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4150 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4151 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4152
4153 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
4154 that are needed. */
4155 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
4156 return;
4157 }
4158 }
4159
4160 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
4161 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
4162
4163 static void
4164 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
4165 {
4166 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
4167 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
4168 if (prev == child)
4169 {
4170 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
4171 prev = NULL;
4172 }
4173 else
4174 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
4175 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
4176 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
4177 }
4178
4179 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
4180 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
4181
4182 static void
4183 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
4184 {
4185 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
4186
4187 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
4188 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
4189
4190 new_child->die_parent = parent;
4191 if (prev == old_child)
4192 {
4193 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
4194 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
4195 }
4196 else
4197 {
4198 prev->die_sib = new_child;
4199 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
4200 }
4201 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
4202 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
4203 }
4204
4205 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
4206
4207 static void
4208 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
4209 {
4210 dw_die_ref c;
4211 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
4212 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
4213 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
4214 }
4215
4216 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
4217 matches TAG. */
4218
4219 static void
4220 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
4221 {
4222 dw_die_ref c;
4223
4224 c = die->die_child;
4225 if (c) do {
4226 dw_die_ref prev = c;
4227 c = c->die_sib;
4228 while (c->die_tag == tag)
4229 {
4230 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
4231 /* Might have removed every child. */
4232 if (c == c->die_sib)
4233 return;
4234 c = c->die_sib;
4235 }
4236 } while (c != die->die_child);
4237 }
4238
4239 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
4240
4241 static void
4242 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
4243 {
4244 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
4245 if (! die || ! child_die)
4246 return;
4247 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
4248
4249 child_die->die_parent = die;
4250 if (die->die_child)
4251 {
4252 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
4253 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
4254 }
4255 else
4256 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
4257 die->die_child = child_die;
4258 }
4259
4260 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
4261 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
4262 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
4263
4264 static void
4265 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
4266 {
4267 dw_die_ref p;
4268
4269 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
4270 specification DIE at toplevel. */
4271 if (child->die_parent != parent)
4272 {
4273 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
4274
4275 if (tmp)
4276 child = tmp;
4277 }
4278
4279 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
4280 || (child->die_parent
4281 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
4282
4283 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
4284 if (p->die_sib == child)
4285 {
4286 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
4287 break;
4288 }
4289
4290 add_child_die (parent, child);
4291 }
4292
4293 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
4294
4295 static inline dw_die_ref
4296 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
4297 {
4298 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
4299
4300 die->die_tag = tag_value;
4301
4302 if (parent_die != NULL)
4303 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
4304 else
4305 {
4306 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
4307
4308 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
4309 limbo_node->die = die;
4310 limbo_node->created_for = t;
4311 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
4312 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
4313 }
4314
4315 return die;
4316 }
4317
4318 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
4319
4320 static inline dw_die_ref
4321 lookup_type_die (tree type)
4322 {
4323 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
4324 }
4325
4326 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
4327 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
4328 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
4329
4330 static inline dw_die_ref
4331 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
4332 {
4333 if (type
4334 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
4335 && type_die
4336 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
4337 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
4338 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
4339 return type_die;
4340 }
4341
4342 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
4343 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
4344 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
4345 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
4346 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
4347 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
4348
4349 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
4350 a naming typedef is. */
4351
4352 static inline dw_die_ref
4353 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
4354 {
4355 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
4356 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
4357 }
4358
4359 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
4360
4361 static inline void
4362 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
4363 {
4364 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
4365 }
4366
4367 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
4368
4369 static hashval_t
4370 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
4371 {
4372 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
4373 }
4374
4375 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
4376
4377 static int
4378 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
4379 {
4380 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
4381 }
4382
4383 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
4384
4385 static inline dw_die_ref
4386 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
4387 {
4388 return (dw_die_ref) htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
4389 }
4390
4391 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
4392
4393 static hashval_t
4394 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
4395 {
4396 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
4397 }
4398
4399 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
4400 UID of decl *Y. */
4401
4402 static int
4403 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
4404 {
4405 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
4406 }
4407
4408 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
4409
4410 static inline var_loc_list *
4411 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
4412 {
4413 if (!decl_loc_table)
4414 return NULL;
4415 return (var_loc_list *)
4416 htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
4417 }
4418
4419 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
4420
4421 static hashval_t
4422 cached_dw_loc_list_table_hash (const void *x)
4423 {
4424 return (hashval_t) ((const cached_dw_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
4425 }
4426
4427 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
4428 UID of decl *Y. */
4429
4430 static int
4431 cached_dw_loc_list_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
4432 {
4433 return (((const cached_dw_loc_list *) x)->decl_id
4434 == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
4435 }
4436
4437 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
4438
4439 static void
4440 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
4441 {
4442 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
4443 void **slot;
4444
4445 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
4446 *slot = decl_die;
4447 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
4448 }
4449
4450 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
4451
4452 static int
4453 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
4454 {
4455 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
4456 if (ret)
4457 return ret;
4458 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
4459 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
4460 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
4461 }
4462
4463 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
4464
4465 static rtx *
4466 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
4467 {
4468 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
4469 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
4470 else
4471 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
4472 }
4473
4474 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
4475 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
4476
4477 static rtx
4478 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
4479 {
4480 if (bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
4481 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
4482 else
4483 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
4484 GEN_INT (bitsize),
4485 loc_note), next);
4486 }
4487
4488 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
4489 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
4490
4491 static rtx
4492 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
4493 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
4494 {
4495 if (bitsize != -1)
4496 {
4497 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
4498 if (bitpos != 0)
4499 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
4500 }
4501 return loc_note;
4502 }
4503
4504 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
4505 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
4506 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
4507 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
4508 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
4509 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
4510 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
4511 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
4512 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
4513
4514 static void
4515 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
4516 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
4517 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
4518 {
4519 int diff;
4520 bool copy = inner != NULL;
4521
4522 if (copy)
4523 {
4524 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
4525 while (src != inner)
4526 {
4527 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
4528 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
4529 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
4530 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
4531 }
4532 }
4533 /* Add padding if needed. */
4534 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
4535 {
4536 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
4537 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
4538 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
4539 }
4540 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
4541 {
4542 gcc_assert (!copy);
4543 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
4544 just update the location for it and return. */
4545 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
4546 return;
4547 }
4548 /* Add the piece that changed. */
4549 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
4550 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
4551 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
4552 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
4553 if (!copy)
4554 src = dest;
4555 while (diff > 0 && *src)
4556 {
4557 rtx piece = *src;
4558 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
4559 if (copy)
4560 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
4561 else
4562 {
4563 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
4564 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
4565 }
4566 }
4567 /* Add padding if needed. */
4568 if (diff < 0 && *src)
4569 {
4570 if (!copy)
4571 dest = src;
4572 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
4573 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
4574 }
4575 if (!copy)
4576 return;
4577 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
4578 while (*src)
4579 {
4580 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
4581 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
4582 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
4583 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
4584 }
4585 }
4586
4587 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
4588
4589 static struct var_loc_node *
4590 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
4591 {
4592 unsigned int decl_id;
4593 var_loc_list *temp;
4594 void **slot;
4595 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
4596 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
4597
4598 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl))
4599 {
4600 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
4601 if (realdecl && handled_component_p (realdecl))
4602 {
4603 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
4604 tree innerdecl;
4605 innerdecl
4606 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize);
4607 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
4608 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
4609 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
4610 || bitsize <= 0
4611 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
4612 || bitsize != maxsize)
4613 return NULL;
4614 decl = innerdecl;
4615 }
4616 }
4617
4618 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
4619 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
4620 if (*slot == NULL)
4621 {
4622 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_list ();
4623 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
4624 *slot = temp;
4625 }
4626 else
4627 temp = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
4628
4629 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
4630 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
4631 if (temp->last
4632 && temp->first == temp->last
4633 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
4634 && GET_CODE (temp->first->loc) == NOTE
4635 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
4636 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
4637 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
4638 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
4639 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
4640 && prev_real_insn (temp->first->loc) == NULL_RTX
4641 && (bitsize != -1
4642 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
4643 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
4644 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
4645 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
4646 {
4647 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
4648 temp->first->next = loc;
4649 temp->last = loc;
4650 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
4651 }
4652 else if (temp->last)
4653 {
4654 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
4655 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
4656 int piece_bitpos = 0;
4657 if (last->next)
4658 {
4659 last = last->next;
4660 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
4661 }
4662 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
4663 {
4664 piece_loc = &last->loc;
4665 do
4666 {
4667 int cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
4668 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
4669 break;
4670 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
4671 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
4672 }
4673 while (*piece_loc);
4674 }
4675 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
4676 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
4677 last element. */
4678 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
4679 {
4680 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
4681 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
4682 if (piece_loc != NULL)
4683 {
4684 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
4685 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
4686 return NULL;
4687 }
4688 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
4689 if (temp->last != last)
4690 {
4691 temp->last->next = NULL;
4692 unused = last;
4693 last = temp->last;
4694 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
4695 }
4696 else
4697 {
4698 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
4699 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
4700 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
4701 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
4702 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
4703 return temp->last;
4704 }
4705 }
4706 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
4707 last_loc_note = last->loc;
4708 else if (piece_loc != NULL
4709 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
4710 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
4711 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
4712 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
4713 else
4714 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
4715 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
4716 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
4717 we have nothing to do. */
4718 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
4719 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
4720 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
4721 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
4722 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
4723 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
4724 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
4725 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
4726 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
4727 {
4728 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
4729 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
4730 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
4731 if (unused)
4732 {
4733 loc = unused;
4734 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
4735 }
4736 else
4737 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
4738 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
4739 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
4740 else
4741 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
4742 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
4743 last->next = loc;
4744 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
4745 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
4746 if (last != temp->last)
4747 temp->last = last;
4748 }
4749 else if (unused)
4750 ggc_free (unused);
4751 }
4752 else
4753 {
4754 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
4755 temp->first = loc;
4756 temp->last = loc;
4757 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
4758 }
4759 return loc;
4760 }
4761 \f
4762 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
4763 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
4764 the DIE internal representation. */
4765 static int print_indent;
4766
4767 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
4768
4769 static inline void
4770 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
4771 {
4772 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
4773 }
4774
4775 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
4776
4777 static inline void
4778 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
4779 {
4780 int i;
4781
4782 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
4783 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
4784 }
4785
4786 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
4787 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
4788
4789 static void
4790 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
4791 {
4792 dw_attr_ref a;
4793 dw_die_ref c;
4794 unsigned ix;
4795
4796 print_spaces (outfile);
4797 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
4798 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
4799 (void*) die);
4800 print_spaces (outfile);
4801 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
4802 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
4803 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
4804
4805 if (die->comdat_type_p)
4806 {
4807 print_spaces (outfile);
4808 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
4809 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
4810 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
4811 }
4812
4813 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
4814 {
4815 print_spaces (outfile);
4816 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
4817
4818 switch (AT_class (a))
4819 {
4820 case dw_val_class_addr:
4821 fprintf (outfile, "address");
4822 break;
4823 case dw_val_class_offset:
4824 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
4825 break;
4826 case dw_val_class_loc:
4827 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
4828 break;
4829 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
4830 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
4831 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
4832 break;
4833 case dw_val_class_range_list:
4834 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
4835 break;
4836 case dw_val_class_const:
4837 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
4838 break;
4839 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
4840 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
4841 break;
4842 case dw_val_class_const_double:
4843 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
4844 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
4845 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high,
4846 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low);
4847 break;
4848 case dw_val_class_vec:
4849 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
4850 break;
4851 case dw_val_class_flag:
4852 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
4853 break;
4854 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
4855 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
4856 {
4857 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
4858 {
4859 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
4860 print_signature (outfile,
4861 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
4862 }
4863 else if (AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol)
4864 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s",
4865 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
4866 else
4867 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
4868 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) AT_ref (a));
4869 }
4870 else
4871 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
4872 break;
4873 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
4874 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
4875 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a));
4876 break;
4877 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
4878 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
4879 case dw_val_class_macptr:
4880 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
4881 break;
4882 case dw_val_class_str:
4883 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
4884 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
4885 else
4886 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
4887 break;
4888 case dw_val_class_file:
4889 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
4890 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
4891 break;
4892 case dw_val_class_data8:
4893 {
4894 int i;
4895
4896 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
4897 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i]);
4898 break;
4899 }
4900 default:
4901 break;
4902 }
4903
4904 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
4905 }
4906
4907 if (die->die_child != NULL)
4908 {
4909 print_indent += 4;
4910 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
4911 print_indent -= 4;
4912 }
4913 if (print_indent == 0)
4914 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
4915 }
4916
4917 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
4918
4919 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4920 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
4921 {
4922 print_die (die, stderr);
4923 }
4924
4925 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
4926 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
4927
4928 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4929 debug_dwarf (void)
4930 {
4931 print_indent = 0;
4932 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
4933 }
4934 \f
4935 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
4936 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
4937 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
4938
4939 static dw_die_ref
4940 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
4941 {
4942 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
4943 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
4944
4945 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
4946 return new_unit;
4947 }
4948
4949 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
4950
4951 static dw_die_ref
4952 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
4953 {
4954 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
4955
4956 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
4957 return new_unit;
4958 }
4959
4960 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
4961 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
4962
4963 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
4964
4965 static inline void
4966 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
4967 {
4968 int tem;
4969
4970 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
4971 CHECKSUM (tem);
4972 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
4973 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
4974 }
4975
4976 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
4977
4978 static void
4979 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
4980 {
4981 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4982 rtx r;
4983
4984 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
4985
4986 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
4987 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
4988 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
4989 return;
4990
4991 switch (AT_class (at))
4992 {
4993 case dw_val_class_const:
4994 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
4995 break;
4996 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
4997 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
4998 break;
4999 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5000 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
5001 break;
5002 case dw_val_class_vec:
5003 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5004 break;
5005 case dw_val_class_flag:
5006 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5007 break;
5008 case dw_val_class_str:
5009 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5010 break;
5011
5012 case dw_val_class_addr:
5013 r = AT_addr (at);
5014 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5015 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5016 break;
5017
5018 case dw_val_class_offset:
5019 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5020 break;
5021
5022 case dw_val_class_loc:
5023 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5024 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5025 break;
5026
5027 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5028 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5029 break;
5030
5031 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5032 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5033 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5034 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5035 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5036 break;
5037
5038 case dw_val_class_file:
5039 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5040 break;
5041
5042 case dw_val_class_data8:
5043 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
5044 break;
5045
5046 default:
5047 break;
5048 }
5049 }
5050
5051 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5052
5053 static void
5054 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5055 {
5056 dw_die_ref c;
5057 dw_attr_ref a;
5058 unsigned ix;
5059
5060 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5061 if (die->die_mark)
5062 {
5063 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5064 return;
5065 }
5066 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5067
5068 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5069
5070 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
5071 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5072
5073 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
5074 }
5075
5076 #undef CHECKSUM
5077 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5078
5079 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
5080 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5081 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
5082 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
5083 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
5084 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
5085 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
5086
5087 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
5088
5089 static void
5090 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5091 {
5092 unsigned char byte;
5093 bool more;
5094
5095 while (1)
5096 {
5097 byte = (value & 0x7f);
5098 value >>= 7;
5099 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
5100 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
5101 if (more)
5102 byte |= 0x80;
5103 CHECKSUM (byte);
5104 if (!more)
5105 break;
5106 }
5107 }
5108
5109 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
5110
5111 static void
5112 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5113 {
5114 while (1)
5115 {
5116 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
5117 value >>= 7;
5118 if (value != 0)
5119 /* More bytes to follow. */
5120 byte |= 0x80;
5121 CHECKSUM (byte);
5122 if (value == 0)
5123 break;
5124 }
5125 }
5126
5127 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
5128 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
5129
5130 static void
5131 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5132 {
5133 const char *name;
5134 dw_die_ref spec;
5135 int tag = die->die_tag;
5136
5137 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
5138 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
5139 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
5140 return;
5141
5142 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
5143
5144 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
5145 if (spec != NULL)
5146 die = spec;
5147
5148 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
5149 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
5150
5151 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
5152 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
5153 if (name != NULL)
5154 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
5155 }
5156
5157 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5158
5159 static inline void
5160 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5161 {
5162 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
5163 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
5164 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
5165 {
5166 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
5167 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
5168 return;
5169 }
5170
5171 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
5172 while (loc != NULL)
5173 {
5174 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5175 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5176 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5177 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5178 }
5179 }
5180
5181 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5182
5183 static void
5184 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
5185 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5186 {
5187 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5188 rtx r;
5189
5190 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5191 {
5192 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
5193
5194 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
5195 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
5196 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
5197 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
5198 is complete or not. */
5199 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
5200 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
5201 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
5202 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
5203 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
5204 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
5205 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
5206 {
5207 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
5208
5209 if (name_attr != NULL)
5210 {
5211 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
5212
5213 if (decl == NULL)
5214 decl = target_die;
5215 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
5216 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5217 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
5218 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
5219 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
5220 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
5221 return;
5222 }
5223 }
5224
5225 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
5226 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
5227 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
5228 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
5229 {
5230 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
5231 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5232 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
5233 }
5234 else
5235 {
5236 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
5237
5238 if (decl == NULL)
5239 decl = target_die;
5240 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5241 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
5242 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5243 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
5244 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
5245 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
5246 }
5247 return;
5248 }
5249
5250 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
5251 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5252
5253 switch (AT_class (at))
5254 {
5255 case dw_val_class_const:
5256 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
5257 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5258 break;
5259
5260 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5261 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
5262 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5263 break;
5264
5265 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5266 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
5267 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
5268 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
5269 break;
5270
5271 case dw_val_class_vec:
5272 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
5273 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec));
5274 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5275 break;
5276
5277 case dw_val_class_flag:
5278 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
5279 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
5280 break;
5281
5282 case dw_val_class_str:
5283 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
5284 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5285 break;
5286
5287 case dw_val_class_addr:
5288 r = AT_addr (at);
5289 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5290 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
5291 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5292 break;
5293
5294 case dw_val_class_offset:
5295 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
5296 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5297 break;
5298
5299 case dw_val_class_loc:
5300 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5301 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
5302 break;
5303
5304 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5305 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5306 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5307 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5308 break;
5309
5310 case dw_val_class_file:
5311 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
5312 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5313 break;
5314
5315 case dw_val_class_data8:
5316 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
5317 break;
5318
5319 default:
5320 break;
5321 }
5322 }
5323
5324 struct checksum_attributes
5325 {
5326 dw_attr_ref at_name;
5327 dw_attr_ref at_type;
5328 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
5329 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
5330 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
5331 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
5332 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
5333 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
5334 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
5335 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
5336 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
5337 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
5338 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
5339 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
5340 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
5341 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
5342 dw_attr_ref at_count;
5343 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
5344 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
5345 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
5346 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
5347 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
5348 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
5349 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
5350 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
5351 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
5352 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
5353 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
5354 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
5355 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
5356 dw_attr_ref at_location;
5357 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
5358 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
5359 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
5360 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
5361 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
5362 dw_attr_ref at_small;
5363 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
5364 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
5365 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
5366 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
5367 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
5368 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
5369 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
5370 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
5371 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
5372 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
5373 };
5374
5375 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
5376
5377 static void
5378 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
5379 {
5380 dw_attr_ref a;
5381 unsigned ix;
5382
5383 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
5384 {
5385 switch (a->dw_attr)
5386 {
5387 case DW_AT_name:
5388 attrs->at_name = a;
5389 break;
5390 case DW_AT_type:
5391 attrs->at_type = a;
5392 break;
5393 case DW_AT_friend:
5394 attrs->at_friend = a;
5395 break;
5396 case DW_AT_accessibility:
5397 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
5398 break;
5399 case DW_AT_address_class:
5400 attrs->at_address_class = a;
5401 break;
5402 case DW_AT_allocated:
5403 attrs->at_allocated = a;
5404 break;
5405 case DW_AT_artificial:
5406 attrs->at_artificial = a;
5407 break;
5408 case DW_AT_associated:
5409 attrs->at_associated = a;
5410 break;
5411 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
5412 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
5413 break;
5414 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
5415 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
5416 break;
5417 case DW_AT_bit_size:
5418 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
5419 break;
5420 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
5421 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
5422 break;
5423 case DW_AT_byte_size:
5424 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
5425 break;
5426 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
5427 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
5428 break;
5429 case DW_AT_const_value:
5430 attrs->at_const_value = a;
5431 break;
5432 case DW_AT_containing_type:
5433 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
5434 break;
5435 case DW_AT_count:
5436 attrs->at_count = a;
5437 break;
5438 case DW_AT_data_location:
5439 attrs->at_data_location = a;
5440 break;
5441 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
5442 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
5443 break;
5444 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
5445 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
5446 break;
5447 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
5448 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
5449 break;
5450 case DW_AT_default_value:
5451 attrs->at_default_value = a;
5452 break;
5453 case DW_AT_digit_count:
5454 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
5455 break;
5456 case DW_AT_discr:
5457 attrs->at_discr = a;
5458 break;
5459 case DW_AT_discr_list:
5460 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
5461 break;
5462 case DW_AT_discr_value:
5463 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
5464 break;
5465 case DW_AT_encoding:
5466 attrs->at_encoding = a;
5467 break;
5468 case DW_AT_endianity:
5469 attrs->at_endianity = a;
5470 break;
5471 case DW_AT_explicit:
5472 attrs->at_explicit = a;
5473 break;
5474 case DW_AT_is_optional:
5475 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
5476 break;
5477 case DW_AT_location:
5478 attrs->at_location = a;
5479 break;
5480 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
5481 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
5482 break;
5483 case DW_AT_mutable:
5484 attrs->at_mutable = a;
5485 break;
5486 case DW_AT_ordering:
5487 attrs->at_ordering = a;
5488 break;
5489 case DW_AT_picture_string:
5490 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
5491 break;
5492 case DW_AT_prototyped:
5493 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
5494 break;
5495 case DW_AT_small:
5496 attrs->at_small = a;
5497 break;
5498 case DW_AT_segment:
5499 attrs->at_segment = a;
5500 break;
5501 case DW_AT_string_length:
5502 attrs->at_string_length = a;
5503 break;
5504 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
5505 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
5506 break;
5507 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
5508 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
5509 break;
5510 case DW_AT_use_location:
5511 attrs->at_use_location = a;
5512 break;
5513 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
5514 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
5515 break;
5516 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
5517 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
5518 break;
5519 case DW_AT_virtuality:
5520 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
5521 break;
5522 case DW_AT_visibility:
5523 attrs->at_visibility = a;
5524 break;
5525 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
5526 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
5527 break;
5528 default:
5529 break;
5530 }
5531 }
5532 }
5533
5534 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
5535
5536 static void
5537 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5538 {
5539 dw_die_ref c;
5540 dw_die_ref decl;
5541 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
5542
5543 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
5544 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
5545
5546 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
5547
5548 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
5549 if (decl != NULL)
5550 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
5551 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
5552
5553 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
5554 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
5555 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
5556 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
5557 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
5558 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
5559 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
5560 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
5561 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
5562 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
5563 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
5564 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
5565 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
5566 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
5567 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
5568 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
5569 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
5570 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
5571 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
5572 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
5573 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
5574 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
5575 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
5576 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
5577 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
5578 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
5579 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
5580 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
5581 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
5582 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
5583 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
5584 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
5585 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
5586 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
5587 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
5588 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
5589 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
5590 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
5591 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
5592 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
5593 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
5594 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
5595 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
5596 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
5597 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
5598 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
5599 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
5600
5601 /* Checksum the child DIEs, except for nested types and member functions. */
5602 c = die->die_child;
5603 if (c) do {
5604 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
5605
5606 c = c->die_sib;
5607 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
5608 if ((is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
5609 && name_attr != NULL)
5610 {
5611 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
5612 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
5613 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
5614 }
5615 else
5616 {
5617 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
5618 if (c->die_mark == 0)
5619 c->die_mark = -1;
5620 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
5621 }
5622 } while (c != die->die_child);
5623
5624 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
5625 }
5626
5627 #undef CHECKSUM
5628 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5629 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
5630 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
5631 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
5632
5633 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
5634 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
5635 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
5636 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
5637 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
5638 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
5639 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
5640
5641 static void
5642 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
5643 {
5644 int mark;
5645 const char *name;
5646 unsigned char checksum[16];
5647 struct md5_ctx ctx;
5648 dw_die_ref decl;
5649 dw_die_ref parent;
5650
5651 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
5652 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
5653 parent = get_die_parent (die);
5654
5655 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
5656 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
5657 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
5658
5659 if (is_cxx() && name != NULL)
5660 {
5661 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
5662
5663 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
5664 if (parent != NULL)
5665 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
5666
5667 md5_process_bytes (&die->die_tag, sizeof (die->die_tag), &ctx);
5668 md5_process_bytes (name, strlen (name) + 1, &ctx);
5669 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
5670
5671 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
5672 }
5673
5674 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
5675
5676 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
5677 mark = 1;
5678 die->die_mark = mark;
5679
5680 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
5681 if (parent != NULL)
5682 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
5683
5684 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
5685 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
5686 unmark_all_dies (die);
5687 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
5688
5689 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
5690 type node together. */
5691 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
5692 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
5693 die->comdat_type_p = true;
5694 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
5695 type_node->type_die = die;
5696
5697 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
5698 as well. */
5699 if (decl != NULL)
5700 {
5701 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
5702 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
5703 }
5704 }
5705
5706 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
5707 static inline int
5708 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
5709 {
5710 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
5711 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
5712 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
5713 }
5714
5715 /* Do the values look the same? */
5716 static int
5717 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
5718 {
5719 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
5720 rtx r1, r2;
5721
5722 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
5723 return 0;
5724
5725 switch (v1->val_class)
5726 {
5727 case dw_val_class_const:
5728 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
5729 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5730 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
5731 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5732 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
5733 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
5734 case dw_val_class_vec:
5735 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
5736 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
5737 return 0;
5738 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
5739 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
5740 return 0;
5741 return 1;
5742 case dw_val_class_flag:
5743 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
5744 case dw_val_class_str:
5745 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
5746
5747 case dw_val_class_addr:
5748 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
5749 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
5750 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
5751 return 0;
5752 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
5753
5754 case dw_val_class_offset:
5755 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
5756
5757 case dw_val_class_loc:
5758 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
5759 loc1 && loc2;
5760 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
5761 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
5762 return 0;
5763 return !loc1 && !loc2;
5764
5765 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5766 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
5767
5768 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5769 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5770 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5771 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5772 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5773 return 1;
5774
5775 case dw_val_class_file:
5776 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
5777
5778 case dw_val_class_data8:
5779 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
5780
5781 default:
5782 return 1;
5783 }
5784 }
5785
5786 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
5787
5788 static int
5789 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
5790 {
5791 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
5792 return 0;
5793
5794 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5795 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5796 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5797 return 1;
5798
5799 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
5800 }
5801
5802 /* Do the dies look the same? */
5803
5804 static int
5805 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
5806 {
5807 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
5808 dw_attr_ref a1;
5809 unsigned ix;
5810
5811 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5812 if (die1->die_mark)
5813 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
5814 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5815
5816 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
5817 return 0;
5818
5819 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
5820 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
5821 return 0;
5822
5823 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
5824 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
5825 return 0;
5826
5827 c1 = die1->die_child;
5828 c2 = die2->die_child;
5829 if (! c1)
5830 {
5831 if (c2)
5832 return 0;
5833 }
5834 else
5835 for (;;)
5836 {
5837 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
5838 return 0;
5839 c1 = c1->die_sib;
5840 c2 = c2->die_sib;
5841 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
5842 {
5843 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
5844 break;
5845 else
5846 return 0;
5847 }
5848 }
5849
5850 return 1;
5851 }
5852
5853 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
5854
5855 static int
5856 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
5857 {
5858 int mark = 0;
5859 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
5860
5861 unmark_all_dies (die1);
5862 unmark_all_dies (die2);
5863
5864 return ret;
5865 }
5866
5867 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
5868 info section. */
5869 static const char *comdat_symbol_id;
5870
5871 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
5872 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
5873
5874 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
5875 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
5876
5877 static void
5878 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
5879 {
5880 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
5881 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
5882 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
5883 char *p;
5884 int i, mark;
5885 unsigned char checksum[16];
5886 struct md5_ctx ctx;
5887
5888 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
5889 the name filename of the unit. */
5890
5891 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
5892 mark = 0;
5893 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
5894 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
5895 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
5896
5897 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
5898 clean_symbol_name (name);
5899
5900 p = name + strlen (name);
5901 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
5902 {
5903 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
5904 p += 2;
5905 }
5906
5907 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
5908 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
5909 }
5910
5911 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
5912
5913 static int
5914 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
5915 {
5916 switch (die->die_tag)
5917 {
5918 case DW_TAG_array_type:
5919 case DW_TAG_class_type:
5920 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
5921 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
5922 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
5923 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
5924 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
5925 case DW_TAG_string_type:
5926 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
5927 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
5928 case DW_TAG_union_type:
5929 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
5930 case DW_TAG_set_type:
5931 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
5932 case DW_TAG_base_type:
5933 case DW_TAG_const_type:
5934 case DW_TAG_file_type:
5935 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
5936 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
5937 case DW_TAG_typedef:
5938 return 1;
5939 default:
5940 return 0;
5941 }
5942 }
5943
5944 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
5945 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
5946 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
5947 compilations (functions). */
5948
5949 static int
5950 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
5951 {
5952 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
5953 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
5954 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
5955 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
5956
5957 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
5958 return 0;
5959
5960 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
5961 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
5962 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
5963 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
5964 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
5965 {
5966 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
5967
5968 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
5969 }
5970
5971 return is_type_die (c);
5972 }
5973
5974 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
5975 compilation unit. */
5976
5977 static int
5978 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
5979 {
5980 return (is_type_die (c)
5981 || is_declaration_die (c)
5982 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
5983 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
5984 }
5985
5986 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
5987
5988 static inline bool
5989 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
5990 {
5991 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit;
5992 }
5993
5994 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
5995
5996 static inline bool
5997 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
5998 {
5999 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
6000 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
6001 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit);
6002 }
6003
6004 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
6005
6006 static inline bool
6007 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
6008 {
6009 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
6010 }
6011
6012 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
6013
6014 static inline bool
6015 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
6016 {
6017 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
6018 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
6019 }
6020
6021 static char *
6022 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6023 {
6024 char buf[256];
6025
6026 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6027 return xstrdup (buf);
6028 }
6029
6030 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6031
6032 static void
6033 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6034 {
6035 dw_die_ref c;
6036
6037 if (is_symbol_die (die) && !die->comdat_type_p)
6038 {
6039 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6040 {
6041 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6042
6043 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6044 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6045 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6046 }
6047 else
6048 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6049 }
6050
6051 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6052 }
6053
6054 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6055 {
6056 dw_die_ref cu;
6057 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6058 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6059 };
6060
6061 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6062 static hashval_t
6063 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6064 {
6065 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry =
6066 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of;
6067
6068 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
6069 }
6070
6071 static int
6072 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6073 {
6074 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry1 =
6075 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of1;
6076 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
6077
6078 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
6079 }
6080
6081 static void
6082 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6083 {
6084 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next,
6085 *entry = (struct cu_hash_table_entry *) what;
6086
6087 while (entry)
6088 {
6089 next = entry->next;
6090 free (entry);
6091 entry = next;
6092 }
6093 }
6094
6095 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6096 accordingly. */
6097 static int
6098 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6099 {
6100 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6101 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6102
6103 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6104
6105 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6106 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
6107 INSERT);
6108 entry = *slot;
6109
6110 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6111 {
6112 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6113 break;
6114 }
6115
6116 if (entry)
6117 {
6118 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6119 return 1;
6120 }
6121
6122 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6123 entry->cu = cu;
6124 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6125 entry->next = *slot;
6126 *slot = entry;
6127
6128 return 0;
6129 }
6130
6131 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6132 static void
6133 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6134 {
6135 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6136
6137 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6138 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
6139 NO_INSERT);
6140 entry = *slot;
6141
6142 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6143 }
6144
6145 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6146 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6147 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6148
6149 static void
6150 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6151 {
6152 dw_die_ref c;
6153 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6154 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6155 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6156
6157 c = die->die_child;
6158 if (c) do {
6159 dw_die_ref prev = c;
6160 c = c->die_sib;
6161 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6162 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6163 {
6164 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6165
6166 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6167 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6168
6169 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6170 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6171 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6172 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6173 else
6174 add_child_die (unit, c);
6175 c = next;
6176 if (c == die->die_child)
6177 break;
6178 }
6179 } while (c != die->die_child);
6180
6181 #if 0
6182 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6183 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6184 gcc_assert (!unit);
6185 #endif
6186
6187 assign_symbol_names (die);
6188 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6189 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6190 node;
6191 node = node->next)
6192 {
6193 int is_dupl;
6194
6195 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6196 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6197 &comdat_symbol_number);
6198 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6199 if (is_dupl)
6200 *pnode = node->next;
6201 else
6202 {
6203 pnode = &node->next;
6204 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6205 comdat_symbol_number);
6206 }
6207 }
6208 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6209 }
6210
6211 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
6212
6213 static int
6214 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
6215 {
6216 dw_attr_ref a;
6217 unsigned ix;
6218
6219 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
6220 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
6221 return 1;
6222
6223 return 0;
6224 }
6225
6226 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
6227
6228 static int
6229 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
6230 {
6231 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6232
6233 if (decl == NULL)
6234 decl = die;
6235 return local_scope_p (decl);
6236 }
6237
6238 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
6239 subprogram. */
6240
6241 static int
6242 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
6243 {
6244 dw_die_ref c;
6245
6246 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
6247 return 1;
6248 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition(c)) return 1);
6249 return 0;
6250 }
6251
6252 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
6253 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
6254
6255 static int
6256 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
6257 {
6258 switch (die->die_tag)
6259 {
6260 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6261 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6262 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6263 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6264 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, or types nested in a
6265 subprogram. */
6266 if (is_declaration_die (die)
6267 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
6268 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die))
6269 return 0;
6270 /* A type definition should never contain a subprogram definition. */
6271 gcc_assert (!contains_subprogram_definition (die));
6272 return 1;
6273 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6274 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6275 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6276 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6277 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6278 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6279 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6280 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6281 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6282 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6283 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6284 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6285 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6286 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6287 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6288 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6289 default:
6290 return 0;
6291 }
6292 }
6293
6294 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
6295
6296 static dw_die_ref
6297 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
6298 {
6299 dw_die_ref clone;
6300 dw_attr_ref a;
6301 unsigned ix;
6302
6303 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
6304 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
6305
6306 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
6307 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
6308
6309 return clone;
6310 }
6311
6312 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
6313
6314 static dw_die_ref
6315 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
6316 {
6317 dw_die_ref c;
6318 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
6319
6320 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree(c)));
6321
6322 return clone;
6323 }
6324
6325 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
6326
6327 static dw_die_ref
6328 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
6329 {
6330 dw_die_ref clone;
6331 dw_die_ref decl;
6332 dw_attr_ref a;
6333 unsigned ix;
6334
6335 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
6336 if (is_declaration_die (die))
6337 return clone_die (die);
6338
6339 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
6340 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6341 if (decl != NULL)
6342 {
6343 clone = clone_die (decl);
6344 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6345 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
6346 return clone;
6347 }
6348
6349 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
6350 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
6351
6352 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
6353 {
6354 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
6355 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
6356 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
6357
6358 switch (a->dw_attr)
6359 {
6360 case DW_AT_artificial:
6361 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6362 case DW_AT_external:
6363 case DW_AT_name:
6364 case DW_AT_type:
6365 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6366 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
6367 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
6368 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
6369 break;
6370 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6371 default:
6372 break;
6373 }
6374 }
6375
6376 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6377 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
6378
6379 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
6380 return clone;
6381 }
6382
6383 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
6384 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
6385 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
6386 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
6387 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
6388
6389 static dw_die_ref
6390 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
6391 {
6392 dw_die_ref decl;
6393 dw_die_ref new_decl;
6394 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
6395
6396 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6397 if (decl == NULL)
6398 decl = die;
6399 else
6400 {
6401 unsigned ix;
6402 dw_die_ref c;
6403 dw_attr_ref a;
6404
6405 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
6406 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
6407 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
6408
6409 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
6410 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
6411 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
6412 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
6413
6414 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
6415
6416 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, decl->die_attr, ix, a)
6417 {
6418 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
6419 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
6420 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
6421 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
6422 }
6423
6424 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree(c)));
6425 }
6426
6427 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
6428 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
6429 {
6430 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
6431 if (new_decl != NULL)
6432 {
6433 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
6434 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
6435 }
6436 }
6437
6438 return orig_parent;
6439 }
6440
6441 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
6442 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
6443
6444 static void
6445 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
6446 {
6447 if (node->new_die != NULL)
6448 return;
6449
6450 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
6451
6452 if (node->parent != NULL)
6453 {
6454 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
6455 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
6456 }
6457 }
6458
6459 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
6460 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
6461 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
6462
6463 static void
6464 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
6465 {
6466 skeleton_chain_node node;
6467 dw_die_ref c;
6468 dw_die_ref first;
6469 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
6470 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
6471
6472 node.parent = parent;
6473
6474 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
6475 if (c)
6476 next = c->die_sib;
6477 if (c) do {
6478 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
6479 prev = c;
6480 c = next;
6481 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
6482 node.old_die = c;
6483 node.new_die = NULL;
6484 if (is_declaration_die (c))
6485 {
6486 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
6487 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
6488 all the original's children, where the original came from. */
6489 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
6490 move_all_children (c, clone);
6491
6492 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
6493 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
6494 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
6495 node.new_die = c;
6496 c = clone;
6497 }
6498 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
6499 } while (next != NULL);
6500 }
6501
6502 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
6503
6504 static dw_die_ref
6505 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
6506 {
6507 skeleton_chain_node node;
6508
6509 node.old_die = die;
6510 node.new_die = NULL;
6511 node.parent = NULL;
6512
6513 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
6514 always leave at least a declaration in its place. */
6515 if (die->die_parent != NULL && is_type_die (die->die_parent))
6516 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
6517
6518 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
6519 return node.new_die;
6520 }
6521
6522 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
6523 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
6524 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
6525 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
6526 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
6527 skeleton tree. */
6528
6529 static dw_die_ref
6530 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
6531 dw_die_ref prev)
6532 {
6533 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
6534
6535 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
6536 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
6537 that DIE. */
6538 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
6539
6540 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
6541 if (skeleton == NULL)
6542 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
6543 else
6544 {
6545 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
6546 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
6547
6548 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
6549 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
6550 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
6551 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
6552 references to it. */
6553 if (orig_parent != NULL)
6554 {
6555 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
6556 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
6557 }
6558 else
6559 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
6560 }
6561
6562 return skeleton;
6563 }
6564
6565 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
6566 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
6567
6568 static void
6569 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
6570 {
6571 dw_die_ref c;
6572 dw_die_ref first;
6573 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
6574 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
6575 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6576
6577 first = c = die->die_child;
6578 if (c)
6579 next = c->die_sib;
6580 if (c) do {
6581 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
6582 prev = c;
6583 c = next;
6584 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
6585 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
6586 {
6587 dw_die_ref replacement;
6588 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
6589
6590 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
6591 add it to the list of comdat types. */
6592 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
6593 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
6594 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
6595 type_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_comdat_type_node ();
6596 type_node->root_die = unit;
6597 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
6598 comdat_type_list = type_node;
6599
6600 /* Generate the type signature. */
6601 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
6602
6603 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
6604 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
6605 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
6606 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
6607 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
6608
6609 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
6610 break_out_comdat_types (c);
6611
6612 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
6613 add_child_die (unit, c);
6614
6615 if (replacement != NULL)
6616 c = replacement;
6617 }
6618 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
6619 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
6620 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
6621 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
6622 {
6623 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
6624 break_out_comdat_types (c);
6625 }
6626 } while (next != NULL);
6627 }
6628
6629 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
6630
6631 struct decl_table_entry
6632 {
6633 dw_die_ref orig;
6634 dw_die_ref copy;
6635 };
6636
6637 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
6638
6639 static hashval_t
6640 htab_decl_hash (const void *of)
6641 {
6642 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry =
6643 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of;
6644
6645 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
6646 }
6647
6648 static int
6649 htab_decl_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6650 {
6651 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry1 =
6652 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of1;
6653 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
6654
6655 return entry1->orig == entry2;
6656 }
6657
6658 static void
6659 htab_decl_del (void *what)
6660 {
6661 struct decl_table_entry *entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) what;
6662
6663 free (entry);
6664 }
6665
6666 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
6667 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
6668 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
6669 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
6670
6671 static dw_die_ref
6672 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
6673 {
6674 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
6675 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
6676 dw_die_ref copy;
6677 void **slot = NULL;
6678 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
6679
6680 if (decl_table)
6681 {
6682 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
6683 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
6684 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
6685 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
6686 {
6687 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
6688 return entry->copy;
6689 }
6690
6691 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
6692 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
6693 entry->orig = die;
6694 entry->copy = NULL;
6695 *slot = entry;
6696 }
6697
6698 if (parent != NULL)
6699 {
6700 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
6701 if (spec != NULL)
6702 parent = spec;
6703 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
6704 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
6705 }
6706
6707 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
6708 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
6709
6710 if (decl_table != NULL)
6711 {
6712 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
6713 entry->copy = copy;
6714 }
6715
6716 return copy;
6717 }
6718
6719 /* Like clone_tree, but additionally enter all the children into
6720 the hash table decl_table. */
6721
6722 static dw_die_ref
6723 clone_tree_hash (dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
6724 {
6725 dw_die_ref c;
6726 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
6727 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
6728 void **slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
6729 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
6730 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
6731 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
6732 clone_tree_hash wouldn't be called. */
6733 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
6734 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
6735 entry->orig = die;
6736 entry->copy = clone;
6737 *slot = entry;
6738
6739 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
6740 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_hash (c, decl_table)));
6741
6742 return clone;
6743 }
6744
6745 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
6746 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
6747 type_unit). */
6748
6749 static void
6750 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
6751 {
6752 dw_die_ref c;
6753 dw_attr_ref a;
6754 unsigned ix;
6755
6756 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
6757 {
6758 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6759 {
6760 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
6761 void **slot;
6762 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
6763
6764 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
6765 continue;
6766
6767 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, targ,
6768 htab_hash_pointer (targ), INSERT);
6769
6770 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
6771 {
6772 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
6773 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
6774 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
6775 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
6776 }
6777 else
6778 {
6779 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
6780 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
6781
6782 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
6783 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
6784 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
6785 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
6786 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
6787 entry->orig = targ;
6788 entry->copy = copy;
6789 *slot = entry;
6790
6791 FOR_EACH_CHILD (targ, c,
6792 add_child_die (copy,
6793 clone_tree_hash (c, decl_table)));
6794
6795 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
6796 type unit. */
6797 mark_dies (copy);
6798
6799 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
6800 into the new type unit. */
6801 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
6802 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
6803 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
6804 decl_table);
6805
6806 add_child_die (parent, copy);
6807 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
6808
6809 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
6810 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
6811 get visited otherwise. */
6812 if (parent != unit)
6813 {
6814 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
6815 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
6816 parent->die_mark = 1;
6817 while (parent->die_parent
6818 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
6819 {
6820 parent = parent->die_parent;
6821 parent->die_mark = 1;
6822 }
6823 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
6824 }
6825 }
6826 }
6827 }
6828
6829 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
6830 }
6831
6832 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
6833 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
6834 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
6835 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
6836 don't have an external reference. */
6837
6838 static void
6839 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
6840 {
6841 htab_t decl_table;
6842
6843 mark_dies (unit);
6844 decl_table = htab_create (10, htab_decl_hash, htab_decl_eq, htab_decl_del);
6845 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, decl_table);
6846 htab_delete (decl_table);
6847 unmark_dies (unit);
6848 }
6849
6850 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6851 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6852 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6853
6854 static void
6855 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6856 {
6857 dw_die_ref c;
6858
6859 if (! die->die_child)
6860 return;
6861
6862 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6863 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6864
6865 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6866 }
6867
6868 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6869
6870 static void
6871 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6872 {
6873 dw_die_ref c;
6874 dw_attr_ref a;
6875 unsigned ix;
6876
6877 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
6878 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6879 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6880
6881 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6882 }
6883
6884 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
6885 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
6886 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
6887 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
6888 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
6889 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
6890
6891 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
6892 references. */
6893
6894 struct external_ref
6895 {
6896 dw_die_ref type;
6897 dw_die_ref stub;
6898 unsigned n_refs;
6899 };
6900
6901 /* Hash an external_ref. */
6902
6903 static hashval_t
6904 hash_external_ref (const void *p)
6905 {
6906 const struct external_ref *r = (const struct external_ref *)p;
6907 return htab_hash_pointer (r->type);
6908 }
6909
6910 /* Compare external_refs. */
6911
6912 static int
6913 external_ref_eq (const void *p1, const void *p2)
6914 {
6915 const struct external_ref *r1 = (const struct external_ref *)p1;
6916 const struct external_ref *r2 = (const struct external_ref *)p2;
6917 return r1->type == r2->type;
6918 }
6919
6920 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
6921
6922 static struct external_ref *
6923 lookup_external_ref (htab_t map, dw_die_ref die)
6924 {
6925 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
6926 void ** slot;
6927
6928 ref.type = die;
6929 slot = htab_find_slot (map, &ref, INSERT);
6930 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
6931 return (struct external_ref *) *slot;
6932
6933 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
6934 ref_p->type = die;
6935 *slot = ref_p;
6936 return ref_p;
6937 }
6938
6939 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
6940
6941 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
6942 references, remember how many we've seen. */
6943
6944 static void
6945 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, htab_t map)
6946 {
6947 dw_die_ref c;
6948 dw_attr_ref a;
6949 unsigned ix;
6950 struct external_ref *ref_p;
6951
6952 if (is_type_die (die)
6953 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
6954 {
6955 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
6956 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
6957 ref_p->stub = die;
6958 }
6959
6960 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
6961 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6962 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
6963 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6964 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
6965 && is_type_die (c))
6966 {
6967 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
6968 ref_p->n_refs++;
6969 }
6970
6971 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
6972 }
6973
6974 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
6975 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
6976 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
6977
6978 static int
6979 build_local_stub (void **slot, void *data)
6980 {
6981 struct external_ref *ref_p = (struct external_ref *)*slot;
6982
6983 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
6984 {
6985 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
6986 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
6987 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
6988 dw_die_ref cu = (dw_die_ref) data;
6989 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
6990 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
6991
6992 if (type->comdat_type_p)
6993 {
6994 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
6995 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
6996 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
6997 }
6998 else
6999 {
7000 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
7001 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
7002 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
7003 }
7004
7005 stub->die_mark++;
7006 ref_p->stub = stub;
7007 }
7008 return 1;
7009 }
7010
7011 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
7012 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
7013 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
7014 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
7015
7016 static htab_t
7017 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
7018 {
7019 htab_t map = htab_create (10, hash_external_ref, external_ref_eq, free);
7020 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
7021 htab_traverse (map, build_local_stub, die);
7022 return map;
7023 }
7024
7025 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
7026 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
7027 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
7028 die are visited recursively. */
7029
7030 static void
7031 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, htab_t extern_map)
7032 {
7033 unsigned long abbrev_id;
7034 unsigned int n_alloc;
7035 dw_die_ref c;
7036 dw_attr_ref a;
7037 unsigned ix;
7038
7039 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
7040 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
7041 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
7042 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
7043 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
7044 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
7045 {
7046 struct external_ref *ref_p;
7047 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
7048
7049 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
7050 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
7051 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
7052 else
7053 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
7054 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
7055 }
7056
7057 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
7058 {
7059 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
7060 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
7061 unsigned ix;
7062 bool ok = true;
7063
7064 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
7065 continue;
7066 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
7067 continue;
7068
7069 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
7070 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
7071 continue;
7072
7073 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
7074 {
7075 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
7076 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
7077 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
7078 {
7079 ok = false;
7080 break;
7081 }
7082 }
7083 if (ok)
7084 break;
7085 }
7086
7087 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
7088 {
7089 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
7090 {
7091 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7092 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
7093 n_alloc);
7094
7095 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
7096 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7097 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
7098 }
7099
7100 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
7101 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
7102 }
7103
7104 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
7105 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
7106 }
7107 \f
7108 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
7109
7110 static int
7111 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
7112 {
7113 int log;
7114
7115 if (value == 0)
7116 log = 0;
7117 else
7118 log = floor_log2 (value);
7119
7120 log = log / 8;
7121 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
7122
7123 return log;
7124 }
7125
7126 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
7127 .debug_info section. */
7128
7129 static unsigned long
7130 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
7131 {
7132 unsigned long size = 0;
7133 dw_attr_ref a;
7134 unsigned ix;
7135
7136 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
7137 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
7138 {
7139 switch (AT_class (a))
7140 {
7141 case dw_val_class_addr:
7142 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7143 break;
7144 case dw_val_class_offset:
7145 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7146 break;
7147 case dw_val_class_loc:
7148 {
7149 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7150
7151 /* Block length. */
7152 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7153 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
7154 else
7155 size += constant_size (lsize);
7156 size += lsize;
7157 }
7158 break;
7159 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7160 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7161 break;
7162 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7163 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7164 break;
7165 case dw_val_class_const:
7166 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
7167 break;
7168 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7169 {
7170 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
7171 if (dwarf_version == 3
7172 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
7173 && csize >= 4)
7174 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
7175 else
7176 size += csize;
7177 }
7178 break;
7179 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7180 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
7181 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
7182 size++; /* block */
7183 break;
7184 case dw_val_class_vec:
7185 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7186 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
7187 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7188 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
7189 break;
7190 case dw_val_class_flag:
7191 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7192 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
7193 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
7194 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
7195 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
7196 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
7197 the same abbrev entry. */
7198 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
7199 else
7200 size += 1;
7201 break;
7202 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7203 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7204 {
7205 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
7206 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
7207 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
7208 it's always sized as an offset. */
7209 if (use_debug_types)
7210 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
7211 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
7212 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7213 else
7214 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7215 }
7216 else
7217 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7218 break;
7219 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7220 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7221 break;
7222 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7223 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7224 break;
7225 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7226 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7227 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7228 break;
7229 case dw_val_class_str:
7230 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7231 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7232 else
7233 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
7234 break;
7235 case dw_val_class_file:
7236 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
7237 break;
7238 case dw_val_class_data8:
7239 size += 8;
7240 break;
7241 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7242 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7243 break;
7244 default:
7245 gcc_unreachable ();
7246 }
7247 }
7248
7249 return size;
7250 }
7251
7252 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
7253 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
7254 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
7255 die_offset field in each DIE. */
7256
7257 static void
7258 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
7259 {
7260 dw_die_ref c;
7261
7262 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
7263 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
7264 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
7265 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
7266
7267 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
7268
7269 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7270 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
7271 next_die_offset += 1;
7272 }
7273
7274 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
7275 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
7276 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
7277 values for the base types. */
7278
7279 static void
7280 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
7281 {
7282 unsigned long die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7283 unsigned int i;
7284 dw_die_ref base_type;
7285 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
7286 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
7287 #endif
7288
7289 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
7290 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_die_ref, base_types, i, base_type); i++)
7291 {
7292 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
7293 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
7294 && prev->die_sib == base_type
7295 && base_type->die_child == NULL
7296 && base_type->die_abbrev);
7297 prev = base_type;
7298 #endif
7299 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
7300 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
7301 }
7302 }
7303
7304 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
7305 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
7306 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
7307 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
7308
7309 static void
7310 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
7311 {
7312 dw_die_ref c;
7313
7314 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
7315
7316 die->die_mark = 1;
7317 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
7318 }
7319
7320 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
7321
7322 static void
7323 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
7324 {
7325 dw_die_ref c;
7326
7327 if (! use_debug_types)
7328 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7329
7330 die->die_mark = 0;
7331 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
7332 }
7333
7334 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
7335
7336 static void
7337 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
7338 {
7339 dw_die_ref c;
7340 dw_attr_ref a;
7341 unsigned ix;
7342
7343 if (!die->die_mark)
7344 return;
7345 die->die_mark = 0;
7346
7347 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
7348
7349 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
7350 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7351 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
7352 }
7353
7354 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
7355 generated for the compilation unit. */
7356
7357 static unsigned long
7358 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
7359 {
7360 unsigned long size;
7361 unsigned i;
7362 pubname_ref p;
7363
7364 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
7365 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, names, i, p)
7366 if (names != pubtype_table
7367 || p->die->die_offset != 0
7368 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
7369 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
7370
7371 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7372 return size;
7373 }
7374
7375 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
7376
7377 static unsigned long
7378 size_of_aranges (void)
7379 {
7380 unsigned long size;
7381
7382 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
7383
7384 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
7385 if (text_section_used)
7386 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7387 if (cold_text_section_used)
7388 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7389 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
7390 {
7391 unsigned fde_idx;
7392 dw_fde_ref fde;
7393
7394 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_fde_ref, fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
7395 {
7396 if (!fde->in_std_section)
7397 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7398 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
7399 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7400 }
7401 }
7402
7403 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
7404 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7405 return size;
7406 }
7407 \f
7408 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
7409
7410 static enum dwarf_form
7411 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
7412 {
7413 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
7414 {
7415 case dw_val_class_addr:
7416 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
7417 switch (a->dw_attr)
7418 {
7419 case DW_AT_low_pc:
7420 case DW_AT_high_pc:
7421 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
7422 case DW_AT_trampoline:
7423 return DW_FORM_addr;
7424 default:
7425 break;
7426 }
7427 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
7428 {
7429 case 1:
7430 return DW_FORM_data1;
7431 case 2:
7432 return DW_FORM_data2;
7433 case 4:
7434 return DW_FORM_data4;
7435 case 8:
7436 return DW_FORM_data8;
7437 default:
7438 gcc_unreachable ();
7439 }
7440 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7441 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7442 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7443 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
7444 /* FALLTHRU */
7445 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7446 case dw_val_class_offset:
7447 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
7448 {
7449 case 4:
7450 return DW_FORM_data4;
7451 case 8:
7452 return DW_FORM_data8;
7453 default:
7454 gcc_unreachable ();
7455 }
7456 case dw_val_class_loc:
7457 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7458 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
7459 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
7460 {
7461 case 1:
7462 return DW_FORM_block1;
7463 case 2:
7464 return DW_FORM_block2;
7465 default:
7466 gcc_unreachable ();
7467 }
7468 case dw_val_class_const:
7469 return DW_FORM_sdata;
7470 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7471 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
7472 {
7473 case 1:
7474 return DW_FORM_data1;
7475 case 2:
7476 return DW_FORM_data2;
7477 case 4:
7478 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
7479 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
7480 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
7481 a large constant. */
7482 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
7483 return DW_FORM_udata;
7484 return DW_FORM_data4;
7485 case 8:
7486 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
7487 return DW_FORM_udata;
7488 return DW_FORM_data8;
7489 default:
7490 gcc_unreachable ();
7491 }
7492 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7493 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7494 {
7495 case 8:
7496 return DW_FORM_data2;
7497 case 16:
7498 return DW_FORM_data4;
7499 case 32:
7500 return DW_FORM_data8;
7501 case 64:
7502 default:
7503 return DW_FORM_block1;
7504 }
7505 case dw_val_class_vec:
7506 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7507 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
7508 {
7509 case 1:
7510 return DW_FORM_block1;
7511 case 2:
7512 return DW_FORM_block2;
7513 case 4:
7514 return DW_FORM_block4;
7515 default:
7516 gcc_unreachable ();
7517 }
7518 case dw_val_class_flag:
7519 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7520 {
7521 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
7522 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
7523 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
7524 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
7525 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
7526 the same abbrev entry. */
7527 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
7528 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
7529 }
7530 return DW_FORM_flag;
7531 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7532 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7533 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
7534 else
7535 return DW_FORM_ref;
7536 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7537 return DW_FORM_data;
7538 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7539 return DW_FORM_addr;
7540 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7541 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7542 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
7543 case dw_val_class_str:
7544 return AT_string_form (a);
7545 case dw_val_class_file:
7546 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
7547 {
7548 case 1:
7549 return DW_FORM_data1;
7550 case 2:
7551 return DW_FORM_data2;
7552 case 4:
7553 return DW_FORM_data4;
7554 default:
7555 gcc_unreachable ();
7556 }
7557
7558 case dw_val_class_data8:
7559 return DW_FORM_data8;
7560
7561 default:
7562 gcc_unreachable ();
7563 }
7564 }
7565
7566 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
7567
7568 static void
7569 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
7570 {
7571 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
7572
7573 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
7574 }
7575
7576 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
7577 table. */
7578
7579 static void
7580 output_abbrev_section (void)
7581 {
7582 unsigned long abbrev_id;
7583
7584 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
7585 {
7586 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
7587 unsigned ix;
7588 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
7589
7590 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
7591 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
7592 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
7593
7594 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
7595 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
7596 else
7597 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
7598
7599 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
7600 ix++)
7601 {
7602 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
7603 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
7604 output_value_format (a_attr);
7605 }
7606
7607 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
7608 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
7609 }
7610
7611 /* Terminate the table. */
7612 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
7613 }
7614
7615 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
7616
7617 static inline void
7618 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
7619 {
7620 const char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
7621
7622 gcc_assert (!die->comdat_type_p);
7623
7624 if (sym == 0)
7625 return;
7626
7627 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
7628 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
7629 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
7630 will break. */
7631 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
7632
7633 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
7634 }
7635
7636 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
7637 expression. */
7638
7639 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7640 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
7641 const char *section)
7642 {
7643 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_list_node ();
7644
7645 retlist->begin = begin;
7646 retlist->end = end;
7647 retlist->expr = expr;
7648 retlist->section = section;
7649
7650 return retlist;
7651 }
7652
7653 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
7654 hasn't got one yet. */
7655
7656 static inline void
7657 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
7658 {
7659 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
7660 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
7661 }
7662
7663 /* Output the location list given to us. */
7664
7665 static void
7666 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7667 {
7668 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7669
7670 if (list_head->emitted)
7671 return;
7672 list_head->emitted = true;
7673
7674 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7675
7676 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
7677 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7678 {
7679 unsigned long size;
7680 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
7681 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
7682 continue;
7683 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7684 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
7685 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
7686 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
7687 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
7688 if (size > 0xffff)
7689 continue;
7690 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7691 {
7692 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7693 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7694 list_head->ll_symbol);
7695 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7696 "Location list end address (%s)",
7697 list_head->ll_symbol);
7698 }
7699 else
7700 {
7701 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7702 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7703 list_head->ll_symbol);
7704 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7705 "Location list end address (%s)",
7706 list_head->ll_symbol);
7707 }
7708
7709 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7710 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7711 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7712
7713 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
7714 }
7715
7716 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7717 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7718 list_head->ll_symbol);
7719 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7720 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7721 list_head->ll_symbol);
7722 }
7723
7724 /* Output a type signature. */
7725
7726 static inline void
7727 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
7728 {
7729 int i;
7730
7731 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
7732 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
7733 }
7734
7735 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
7736 the definitions of each child DIE. */
7737
7738 static void
7739 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7740 {
7741 dw_attr_ref a;
7742 dw_die_ref c;
7743 unsigned long size;
7744 unsigned ix;
7745
7746 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7747 them to point to. */
7748 if (! die->comdat_type_p && die->die_id.die_symbol)
7749 output_die_symbol (die);
7750
7751 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
7752 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
7753 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7754
7755 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
7756 {
7757 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7758
7759 switch (AT_class (a))
7760 {
7761 case dw_val_class_addr:
7762 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7763 break;
7764
7765 case dw_val_class_offset:
7766 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7767 "%s", name);
7768 break;
7769
7770 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7771 {
7772 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7773
7774 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7775 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7776 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7777 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7778 *p = '\0';
7779 }
7780 break;
7781
7782 case dw_val_class_loc:
7783 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7784
7785 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7786 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7787 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
7788 else
7789 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7790
7791 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
7792 break;
7793
7794 case dw_val_class_const:
7795 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7796 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7797 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7798 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7799 break;
7800
7801 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7802 {
7803 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
7804 if (dwarf_version == 3
7805 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
7806 && csize >= 4)
7807 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7808 else
7809 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7810 }
7811 break;
7812
7813 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7814 {
7815 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7816
7817 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
7818 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7819 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
7820 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7821 NULL);
7822
7823 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7824 {
7825 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
7826 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
7827 }
7828 else
7829 {
7830 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
7831 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
7832 }
7833
7834 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7835 first, name);
7836 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7837 second, NULL);
7838 }
7839 break;
7840
7841 case dw_val_class_vec:
7842 {
7843 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7844 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7845 unsigned int i;
7846 unsigned char *p;
7847
7848 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
7849 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7850 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7851 {
7852 elt_size /= 2;
7853 len *= 2;
7854 }
7855 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7856 i < len;
7857 i++, p += elt_size)
7858 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7859 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7860 break;
7861 }
7862
7863 case dw_val_class_flag:
7864 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
7865 {
7866 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
7867 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
7868 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
7869 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
7870 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
7871 the same abbrev entry. */
7872 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
7873 if (flag_debug_asm)
7874 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
7875 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
7876 break;
7877 }
7878 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7879 break;
7880
7881 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7882 {
7883 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7884
7885 gcc_assert (sym);
7886 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7887 "%s", name);
7888 }
7889 break;
7890
7891 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7892 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7893 {
7894 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
7895 {
7896 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
7897 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
7898
7899 gcc_assert (type_node);
7900 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
7901 }
7902 else
7903 {
7904 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
7905 int size;
7906
7907 gcc_assert (sym);
7908 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
7909 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
7910 offset. */
7911 if (dwarf_version == 2)
7912 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7913 else
7914 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
7915 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
7916 name);
7917 }
7918 }
7919 else
7920 {
7921 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7922 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7923 "%s", name);
7924 }
7925 break;
7926
7927 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7928 {
7929 char l1[20];
7930
7931 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7932 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7933 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7934 "%s", name);
7935 }
7936 break;
7937
7938 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7939 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7940 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
7941 "%s", name);
7942 break;
7943
7944 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7945 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7946 break;
7947
7948 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7949 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7950 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7951 break;
7952
7953 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7954 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7955 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7956 break;
7957
7958 case dw_val_class_str:
7959 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7960 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7961 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7962 debug_str_section,
7963 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7964 else
7965 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7966 break;
7967
7968 case dw_val_class_file:
7969 {
7970 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7971
7972 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7973 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7974 break;
7975 }
7976
7977 case dw_val_class_data8:
7978 {
7979 int i;
7980
7981 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
7982 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
7983 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
7984 break;
7985 }
7986
7987 default:
7988 gcc_unreachable ();
7989 }
7990 }
7991
7992 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7993
7994 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7995 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7996 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
7997 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
7998 }
7999
8000 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
8001 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
8002
8003 static void
8004 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
8005 {
8006 int ver = dwarf_version;
8007
8008 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
8009 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
8010 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
8011 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
8012 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
8013 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
8014 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
8015 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
8016 debug_abbrev_section,
8017 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
8018 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
8019 }
8020
8021 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
8022
8023 static void
8024 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
8025 {
8026 const char *secname, *oldsym;
8027 char *tmp;
8028 htab_t extern_map;
8029
8030 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
8031 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
8032 return;
8033
8034 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
8035 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
8036 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
8037 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
8038 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
8039 mark_dies (die);
8040
8041 extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
8042
8043 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
8044
8045 htab_delete (extern_map);
8046
8047 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
8048 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
8049 calc_die_sizes (die);
8050
8051 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
8052 if (oldsym)
8053 {
8054 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
8055
8056 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
8057 secname = tmp;
8058 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
8059 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
8060 }
8061 else
8062 {
8063 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
8064 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
8065 info_section_emitted = true;
8066 }
8067
8068 /* Output debugging information. */
8069 output_compilation_unit_header ();
8070 output_die (die);
8071
8072 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
8073 output_pubnames. */
8074 if (oldsym)
8075 {
8076 unmark_dies (die);
8077 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
8078 }
8079 }
8080
8081 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
8082 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
8083 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
8084
8085 static inline bool
8086 want_pubnames (void)
8087 {
8088 return (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1
8089 ? debug_generate_pub_sections
8090 : targetm.want_debug_pub_sections);
8091 }
8092
8093 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
8094
8095 static void
8096 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
8097 {
8098 if (want_pubnames ())
8099 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
8100 }
8101
8102 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
8103
8104 static void
8105 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
8106 {
8107 const char *secname;
8108 char *tmp;
8109 int i;
8110 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
8111 tree comdat_key;
8112 #endif
8113 htab_t extern_map;
8114
8115 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
8116 mark_dies (node->root_die);
8117
8118 extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
8119
8120 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
8121
8122 htab_delete (extern_map);
8123
8124 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
8125 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
8126 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
8127
8128 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
8129 secname = ".debug_types";
8130 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
8131 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
8132 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
8133 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
8134 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
8135 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
8136 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
8137 comdat_key);
8138 #else
8139 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
8140 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
8141 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
8142 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
8143 secname = tmp;
8144 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
8145 #endif
8146
8147 /* Output debugging information. */
8148 output_compilation_unit_header ();
8149 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
8150 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
8151 "Offset to Type DIE");
8152 output_die (node->root_die);
8153
8154 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
8155 }
8156
8157 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
8158
8159 static const char *
8160 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
8161 {
8162 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
8163 return NULL;
8164 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
8165 }
8166
8167 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
8168
8169 static void
8170 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
8171 {
8172 pubname_entry e;
8173
8174 e.die = die;
8175 e.name = xstrdup (str);
8176 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
8177 }
8178
8179 static void
8180 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
8181 {
8182 if (!want_pubnames ())
8183 return;
8184
8185 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
8186 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
8187 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
8188 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
8189 faster than searching the index. */
8190 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !is_class_die (die->die_parent))
8191 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
8192 {
8193 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
8194
8195 if (name)
8196 add_pubname_string (name, die);
8197 }
8198 }
8199
8200 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
8201
8202 static void
8203 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
8204 {
8205 pubname_entry e;
8206
8207 gcc_assert (scope_name);
8208 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
8209 e.die = die;
8210 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
8211 }
8212
8213 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
8214
8215 static void
8216 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
8217 {
8218 pubname_entry e;
8219
8220 if (!want_pubnames ())
8221 return;
8222
8223 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
8224 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
8225 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
8226 {
8227 tree scope = NULL;
8228 const char *scope_name = "";
8229 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
8230 const char *name;
8231
8232 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
8233 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
8234 {
8235 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
8236 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
8237 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
8238 else
8239 scope_name = "";
8240 }
8241
8242 if (TYPE_P (decl))
8243 name = type_tag (decl);
8244 else
8245 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
8246
8247 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
8248 it to the table. */
8249 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
8250 {
8251 e.die = die;
8252 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
8253 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
8254 }
8255
8256 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
8257 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
8258 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
8259 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
8260 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
8261 enums don't have names. */
8262 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
8263 {
8264 dw_die_ref c;
8265
8266 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
8267 }
8268 }
8269 }
8270
8271 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
8272 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
8273
8274 static void
8275 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
8276 {
8277 unsigned i;
8278 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
8279 pubname_ref pub;
8280
8281 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
8282 return;
8283 if (names == pubname_table)
8284 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
8285 else
8286 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
8287 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
8288 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
8289 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
8290 if (names == pubname_table)
8291 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
8292 "Length of Public Names Info");
8293 else
8294 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
8295 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
8296 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
8297 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
8298 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
8299 debug_info_section,
8300 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
8301 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
8302 "Compilation Unit Length");
8303
8304 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, names, i, pub)
8305 {
8306 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the parent
8307 DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned. Don't output
8308 them if that is the case. */
8309 if (pub->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator && !pub->die->die_mark)
8310 continue;
8311
8312 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
8313 if (names == pubname_table)
8314 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
8315
8316 if (names != pubtype_table
8317 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
8318 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
8319 {
8320 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
8321
8322 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
8323 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
8324 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
8325 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
8326 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
8327 {
8328 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
8329
8330 if (type_node != NULL)
8331 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
8332 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
8333 : 0);
8334 }
8335
8336 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
8337
8338 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
8339 }
8340 }
8341
8342 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
8343 }
8344
8345 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
8346 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
8347 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
8348
8349 static void
8350 output_aranges (unsigned long aranges_length)
8351 {
8352 unsigned i;
8353
8354 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
8355 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
8356 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
8357 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
8358 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
8359 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
8360 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
8361 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
8362 debug_info_section,
8363 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
8364 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
8365 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
8366
8367 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
8368 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
8369 {
8370 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
8371 pointer size. */
8372 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
8373 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
8374 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
8375 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
8376 }
8377
8378 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
8379 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
8380 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
8381 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
8382 confused with the terminator. */
8383 if (text_section_used)
8384 {
8385 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
8386 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
8387 text_section_label, "Length");
8388 }
8389 if (cold_text_section_used)
8390 {
8391 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
8392 "Address");
8393 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
8394 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
8395 }
8396
8397 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
8398 {
8399 unsigned fde_idx;
8400 dw_fde_ref fde;
8401
8402 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_fde_ref, fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
8403 {
8404 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
8405 continue;
8406 if (!fde->in_std_section)
8407 {
8408 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
8409 "Address");
8410 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
8411 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
8412 }
8413 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
8414 {
8415 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
8416 "Address");
8417 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
8418 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
8419 }
8420 }
8421 }
8422
8423 /* Output the terminator words. */
8424 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
8425 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
8426 }
8427
8428 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
8429 was placed. */
8430
8431 static unsigned int
8432 add_ranges_num (int num)
8433 {
8434 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
8435
8436 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
8437 {
8438 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
8439 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
8440 ranges_table_allocated);
8441 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
8442 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
8443 }
8444
8445 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
8446 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
8447
8448 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8449 }
8450
8451 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
8452 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
8453
8454 static unsigned int
8455 add_ranges (const_tree block)
8456 {
8457 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
8458 }
8459
8460 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
8461 labels. */
8462
8463 static void
8464 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
8465 bool *added)
8466 {
8467 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
8468 unsigned int offset;
8469
8470 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
8471 {
8472 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
8473 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
8474 ranges_by_label,
8475 ranges_by_label_allocated);
8476 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
8477 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
8478 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
8479 }
8480
8481 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
8482 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
8483 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
8484
8485 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
8486 if (!*added)
8487 {
8488 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset);
8489 *added = true;
8490 }
8491 }
8492
8493 static void
8494 output_ranges (void)
8495 {
8496 unsigned i;
8497 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
8498 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
8499
8500 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
8501 {
8502 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
8503
8504 if (block_num > 0)
8505 {
8506 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
8507 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
8508
8509 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
8510 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
8511
8512 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
8513 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
8514 base of the text section. */
8515 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
8516 {
8517 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
8518 text_section_label,
8519 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
8520 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
8521 text_section_label, NULL);
8522 }
8523
8524 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
8525 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
8526 about whether the target supports cross-section
8527 arithmetic. */
8528 else
8529 {
8530 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
8531 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
8532 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
8533 }
8534
8535 fmt = NULL;
8536 }
8537
8538 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
8539 else if (block_num < 0)
8540 {
8541 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
8542
8543 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
8544 {
8545 gcc_unreachable ();
8546 #if 0
8547 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
8548 function section, all we have to do is to take out
8549 the #if 0 above. */
8550 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
8551 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
8552 text_section_label,
8553 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
8554 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
8555 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
8556 text_section_label, NULL);
8557 #endif
8558 }
8559 else
8560 {
8561 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
8562 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
8563 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
8564 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
8565 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
8566 NULL);
8567 }
8568 }
8569 else
8570 {
8571 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
8572 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
8573 fmt = start_fmt;
8574 }
8575 }
8576 }
8577
8578 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
8579 struct file_info
8580 {
8581 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
8582 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
8583 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
8584 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
8585 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
8586 };
8587
8588 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
8589 files. */
8590 struct dir_info
8591 {
8592 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
8593 int length; /* Path length. */
8594 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
8595 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
8596 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
8597 };
8598
8599 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
8600 the directories in the path. */
8601
8602 static int
8603 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
8604 {
8605 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
8606 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
8607 const unsigned char *cp1;
8608 const unsigned char *cp2;
8609
8610 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
8611 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
8612 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
8613 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
8614 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
8615 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
8616 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
8617
8618 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
8619 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
8620
8621 while (1)
8622 {
8623 ++cp1;
8624 ++cp2;
8625 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
8626 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
8627 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
8628 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
8629 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
8630
8631 /* Character of current path component the same? */
8632 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
8633 return *cp1 - *cp2;
8634 }
8635 }
8636
8637 struct file_name_acquire_data
8638 {
8639 struct file_info *files;
8640 int used_files;
8641 int max_files;
8642 };
8643
8644 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
8645
8646 static int
8647 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
8648 {
8649 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = (struct file_name_acquire_data *) data;
8650 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
8651 struct file_info *fi;
8652 const char *f;
8653
8654 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
8655
8656 if (! d->emitted_number)
8657 return 1;
8658
8659 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
8660
8661 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
8662
8663 /* Skip all leading "./". */
8664 f = d->filename;
8665 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
8666 f += 2;
8667
8668 /* Create a new array entry. */
8669 fi->path = f;
8670 fi->length = strlen (f);
8671 fi->file_idx = d;
8672
8673 /* Search for the file name part. */
8674 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
8675 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
8676 {
8677 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
8678
8679 if (g != NULL)
8680 {
8681 if (f == NULL || f < g)
8682 f = g;
8683 }
8684 }
8685 #endif
8686
8687 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
8688 return 1;
8689 }
8690
8691 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
8692 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
8693 slowdowns with many input files. */
8694
8695 static void
8696 output_file_names (void)
8697 {
8698 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
8699 int numfiles;
8700 struct file_info *files;
8701 struct dir_info *dirs;
8702 int *saved;
8703 int *savehere;
8704 int *backmap;
8705 int ndirs;
8706 int idx_offset;
8707 int i;
8708
8709 if (!last_emitted_file)
8710 {
8711 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
8712 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
8713 return;
8714 }
8715
8716 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
8717
8718 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
8719 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
8720 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
8721
8722 fnad.files = files;
8723 fnad.used_files = 0;
8724 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
8725 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
8726 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
8727
8728 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
8729
8730 /* Find all the different directories used. */
8731 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
8732 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
8733 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
8734 dirs[0].count = 1;
8735 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
8736 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
8737 ndirs = 1;
8738
8739 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
8740 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
8741 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
8742 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
8743 {
8744 /* Same directory as last entry. */
8745 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
8746 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
8747 }
8748 else
8749 {
8750 int j;
8751
8752 /* This is a new directory. */
8753 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
8754 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
8755 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
8756 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
8757 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
8758
8759 /* Search for a prefix. */
8760 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
8761 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
8762 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
8763 && dirs[j].length > 1
8764 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
8765 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
8766 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
8767 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
8768
8769 ++ndirs;
8770 }
8771
8772 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
8773 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
8774 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
8775 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
8776 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
8777 results in most cases and never is much off. */
8778 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
8779 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
8780
8781 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
8782 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
8783 {
8784 int j;
8785 int total;
8786
8787 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
8788 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
8789 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
8790 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
8791
8792 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
8793 {
8794 savehere[j] = 0;
8795 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
8796 {
8797 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
8798 dirs[j] path. */
8799 int k;
8800
8801 k = dirs[j].prefix;
8802 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
8803 k = dirs[k].prefix;
8804
8805 if (k == (int) i)
8806 {
8807 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
8808 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
8809 dirs[i]. */
8810 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
8811 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
8812 }
8813 }
8814 }
8815
8816 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
8817 directory. */
8818 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
8819 {
8820 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
8821 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
8822 if (savehere[j] > 0)
8823 {
8824 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
8825 saved[j] = savehere[j];
8826
8827 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
8828 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
8829 }
8830 }
8831 }
8832
8833 /* Emit the directory name table. */
8834 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
8835 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
8836 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
8837 dirs[i].length
8838 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
8839 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
8840
8841 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
8842
8843 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
8844 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
8845 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
8846 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
8847 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
8848 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
8849
8850 /* Now write all the file names. */
8851 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
8852 {
8853 int file_idx = backmap[i];
8854 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
8855
8856 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8857 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
8858
8859 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
8860 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
8861
8862 int ver;
8863 long long cdt;
8864 long siz;
8865 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
8866 + dirs[dir_idx].length
8867 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
8868 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
8869
8870 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
8871 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
8872 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
8873
8874 dw2_asm_output_nstring
8875 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
8876
8877 /* Include directory index. */
8878 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
8879
8880 /* Modification time. */
8881 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
8882 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
8883 ? cdt : 0,
8884 NULL);
8885
8886 /* File length in bytes. */
8887 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
8888 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
8889 ? siz : 0,
8890 NULL);
8891 #else
8892 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
8893 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
8894
8895 /* Include directory index. */
8896 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
8897
8898 /* Modification time. */
8899 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
8900
8901 /* File length in bytes. */
8902 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
8903 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
8904 }
8905
8906 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
8907 }
8908
8909
8910 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
8911
8912 static void
8913 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
8914 {
8915 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
8916 unsigned int current_line = 1;
8917 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
8918 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
8919 size_t i;
8920
8921 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_line_info_entry, table->entries, i, ent)
8922 {
8923 switch (ent->opcode)
8924 {
8925 case LI_set_address:
8926 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
8927 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
8928 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
8929 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
8930 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
8931 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
8932 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
8933
8934 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
8935 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
8936 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
8937 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8938 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8939 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8940 break;
8941
8942 case LI_set_line:
8943 if (ent->val == current_line)
8944 {
8945 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
8946 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
8947 "copy line %u", current_line);
8948 }
8949 else
8950 {
8951 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
8952 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8953
8954 current_line = ent->val;
8955 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8956 {
8957 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8958 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
8959 This takes 1 byte. */
8960 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8961 "line %u", current_line);
8962 }
8963 else
8964 {
8965 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
8966 depending on the value being encoded. */
8967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8968 "advance to line %u", current_line);
8969 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8970 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
8971 }
8972 }
8973 break;
8974
8975 case LI_set_file:
8976 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
8977 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
8978 break;
8979
8980 case LI_set_column:
8981 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
8982 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
8983 break;
8984
8985 case LI_negate_stmt:
8986 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
8987 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
8988 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
8989 break;
8990
8991 case LI_set_prologue_end:
8992 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
8993 "set prologue end");
8994 break;
8995
8996 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
8997 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
8998 "set epilogue begin");
8999 break;
9000
9001 case LI_set_discriminator:
9002 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
9003 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
9004 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
9005 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
9006 break;
9007 }
9008 }
9009
9010 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
9011 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
9012 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
9013 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
9014 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
9015
9016 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
9017 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
9018 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
9019 }
9020
9021 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
9022 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
9023
9024 static void
9025 output_line_info (void)
9026 {
9027 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
9028 int ver = dwarf_version;
9029 bool saw_one = false;
9030 int opc;
9031
9032 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
9033 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
9034 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
9035 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
9036
9037 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9038 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9039 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9040 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
9041 "Length of Source Line Info");
9042 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
9043
9044 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
9045 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
9046 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
9047
9048 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
9049 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
9050 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
9051 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
9052 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
9053 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
9054 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
9055 and don't let the target override. */
9056 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
9057
9058 if (ver >= 4)
9059 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
9060 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
9061 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
9062 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
9063 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
9064 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
9065 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
9066 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
9067 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
9068 "Special Opcode Base");
9069
9070 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
9071 {
9072 int n_op_args;
9073 switch (opc)
9074 {
9075 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
9076 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
9077 case DW_LNS_set_file:
9078 case DW_LNS_set_column:
9079 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
9080 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
9081 n_op_args = 1;
9082 break;
9083 default:
9084 n_op_args = 0;
9085 break;
9086 }
9087
9088 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
9089 opc, n_op_args);
9090 }
9091
9092 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
9093 output_file_names ();
9094 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
9095
9096 if (separate_line_info)
9097 {
9098 dw_line_info_table *table;
9099 size_t i;
9100
9101 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_line_info_table_p, separate_line_info, i, table)
9102 if (table->in_use)
9103 {
9104 output_one_line_info_table (table);
9105 saw_one = true;
9106 }
9107 }
9108 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
9109 {
9110 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
9111 saw_one = true;
9112 }
9113
9114 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
9115 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
9116 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
9117 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
9118 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
9119 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
9120 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
9121
9122 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
9123 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
9124 }
9125 \f
9126 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
9127 a DIE that describes the given type.
9128
9129 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
9130 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
9131
9132 static dw_die_ref
9133 base_type_die (tree type)
9134 {
9135 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
9136 enum dwarf_type encoding;
9137
9138 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
9139 return 0;
9140
9141 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
9142 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
9143 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
9144 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
9145
9146 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
9147 {
9148 case INTEGER_TYPE:
9149 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
9150 && TYPE_NAME (type)
9151 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
9152 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
9153 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
9154 {
9155 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
9156 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
9157 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
9158 {
9159 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
9160 break;
9161 }
9162 }
9163 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
9164 {
9165 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9166 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
9167 else
9168 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
9169 }
9170 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9171 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
9172 else
9173 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
9174 break;
9175
9176 case REAL_TYPE:
9177 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
9178 {
9179 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
9180 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
9181 else
9182 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
9183 }
9184 else
9185 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
9186 break;
9187
9188 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
9189 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
9190 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
9191 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9192 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
9193 else
9194 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
9195 break;
9196
9197 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
9198 a user defined type for it. */
9199 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
9200 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
9201 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
9202 else
9203 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
9204 break;
9205
9206 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
9207 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
9208 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
9209 break;
9210
9211 default:
9212 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
9213 gcc_unreachable ();
9214 }
9215
9216 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
9217
9218 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
9219 int_size_in_bytes (type));
9220 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
9221 add_pubtype (type, base_type_result);
9222
9223 return base_type_result;
9224 }
9225
9226 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
9227 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
9228
9229 static inline int
9230 is_base_type (tree type)
9231 {
9232 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
9233 {
9234 case ERROR_MARK:
9235 case VOID_TYPE:
9236 case INTEGER_TYPE:
9237 case REAL_TYPE:
9238 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
9239 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
9240 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
9241 return 1;
9242
9243 case ARRAY_TYPE:
9244 case RECORD_TYPE:
9245 case UNION_TYPE:
9246 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
9247 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
9248 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
9249 case METHOD_TYPE:
9250 case POINTER_TYPE:
9251 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
9252 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
9253 case OFFSET_TYPE:
9254 case LANG_TYPE:
9255 case VECTOR_TYPE:
9256 return 0;
9257
9258 default:
9259 gcc_unreachable ();
9260 }
9261
9262 return 0;
9263 }
9264
9265 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
9266 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
9267 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
9268 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
9269 ERROR_MARK node. */
9270
9271 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
9272 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
9273 {
9274 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
9275 return BITS_PER_WORD;
9276 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
9277 return 0;
9278 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
9279 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
9280 else
9281 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
9282 }
9283
9284 /* Similarly, but return a double_int instead of UHWI. */
9285
9286 static inline double_int
9287 double_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
9288 {
9289 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
9290 return uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_WORD);
9291 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
9292 return double_int_zero;
9293 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
9294 return tree_to_double_int (TYPE_SIZE (type));
9295 else
9296 return uhwi_to_double_int (TYPE_ALIGN (type));
9297 }
9298
9299 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
9300 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
9301
9302 static dw_die_ref
9303 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
9304 {
9305 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
9306 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
9307
9308 if (context_die == NULL)
9309 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
9310
9311 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
9312
9313 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
9314 {
9315 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
9316 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
9317 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
9318 }
9319
9320 if (low)
9321 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low);
9322 if (high)
9323 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high);
9324
9325 return subrange_die;
9326 }
9327
9328 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
9329 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
9330
9331 static dw_die_ref
9332 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
9333 dw_die_ref context_die)
9334 {
9335 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
9336 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
9337 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
9338 tree item_type = NULL;
9339 tree qualified_type;
9340 tree name, low, high;
9341 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
9342
9343 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
9344 return NULL;
9345
9346 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
9347 this type. */
9348 qualified_type
9349 = get_qualified_type (type,
9350 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
9351 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
9352
9353 if (qualified_type == sizetype
9354 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
9355 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
9356 {
9357 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
9358
9359 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
9360 && TYPE_PRECISION (t)
9361 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
9362 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
9363 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
9364 qualified_type = t;
9365 }
9366
9367 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
9368 if (qualified_type)
9369 {
9370 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
9371 if (mod_type_die)
9372 return mod_type_die;
9373 }
9374
9375 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
9376
9377 /* Handle C typedef types. */
9378 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
9379 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
9380 {
9381 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
9382
9383 if (qualified_type == dtype)
9384 {
9385 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
9386 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
9387 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
9388 }
9389 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
9390 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
9391 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
9392 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
9393 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
9394 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
9395 type to which it refers. */
9396 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
9397 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
9398 context_die);
9399 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
9400 }
9401
9402 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
9403
9404 if (is_const_type
9405 /* If both is_const_type and is_volatile_type, prefer the path
9406 which leads to a qualified type. */
9407 && (!is_volatile_type
9408 || get_qualified_type (type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST) == NULL_TREE
9409 || get_qualified_type (type, TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE) != NULL_TREE))
9410 {
9411 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, mod_scope, type);
9412 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
9413 }
9414 else if (is_volatile_type)
9415 {
9416 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, mod_scope, type);
9417 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, is_const_type, 0, context_die);
9418 }
9419 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
9420 {
9421 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, mod_scope, type);
9422 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
9423 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9424 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
9425 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
9426 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
9427 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
9428 }
9429 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
9430 {
9431 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
9432 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, mod_scope,
9433 type);
9434 else
9435 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, mod_scope, type);
9436 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
9437 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9438 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
9439 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
9440 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
9441 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
9442 }
9443 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
9444 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
9445 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
9446 {
9447 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
9448 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
9449 }
9450 else if (is_base_type (type))
9451 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
9452 else
9453 {
9454 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
9455
9456 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
9457 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
9458 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
9459 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
9460 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
9461 ..._TYPE node. */
9462 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
9463 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
9464 else
9465 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
9466 not the main variant. */
9467 return lookup_type_die (type);
9468 }
9469
9470 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
9471 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
9472 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
9473 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
9474 if the base type already has the same name. */
9475 if (name
9476 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
9477 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
9478 || (!is_const_type && !is_volatile_type)))
9479 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
9480 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
9481 && DECL_NAME (name))))
9482 {
9483 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
9484 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
9485 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
9486 useful source coordinates anyway. */
9487 name = DECL_NAME (name);
9488 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
9489 }
9490 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
9491 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
9492 {
9493 name = TYPE_NAME (type);
9494 if (name
9495 && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
9496 name = DECL_NAME (name);
9497 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
9498 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
9499 }
9500
9501 if (qualified_type)
9502 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
9503
9504 if (item_type)
9505 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
9506 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
9507 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
9508 types are possible in Ada. */
9509 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
9510 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
9511 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
9512 context_die);
9513
9514 if (sub_die != NULL)
9515 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
9516
9517 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
9518 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
9519 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9520
9521 return mod_type_die;
9522 }
9523
9524 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
9525 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
9526 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
9527
9528 static void
9529 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
9530 {
9531 tree parms, args;
9532 int parms_num, i;
9533 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
9534
9535 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
9536 return;
9537
9538 if (TYPE_P (t))
9539 die = lookup_type_die (t);
9540 else if (DECL_P (t))
9541 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
9542
9543 gcc_assert (die);
9544
9545 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
9546 if (!parms)
9547 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
9548 or function. End of story. */
9549 return;
9550
9551 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
9552 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
9553 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
9554 {
9555 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
9556
9557 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
9558 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
9559 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
9560 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
9561
9562 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
9563 {
9564 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
9565 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
9566 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
9567 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
9568 an argument pack. */
9569 if (arg_pack_elems)
9570 template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
9571 arg_pack_elems,
9572 die);
9573 else
9574 generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
9575 true /* Emit DW_AT_name */, die);
9576 }
9577 }
9578 }
9579
9580 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
9581 the representation of a generic type parameter.
9582 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
9583 ARG is the argument to PARM.
9584 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
9585 name of the PARM.
9586 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
9587 as a child node. */
9588
9589 static dw_die_ref
9590 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
9591 bool emit_name_p,
9592 dw_die_ref parent_die)
9593 {
9594 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
9595 const char *name = NULL;
9596
9597 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
9598 return NULL;
9599
9600 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
9601 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
9602 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
9603 and arguments. */
9604 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
9605 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
9606 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
9607 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
9608 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
9609 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
9610 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
9611 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
9612 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
9613 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
9614 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
9615 name of the template template argument. */
9616 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
9617 parent_die, parm);
9618 else
9619 gcc_unreachable ();
9620
9621 if (tmpl_die)
9622 {
9623 tree tmpl_type;
9624
9625 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
9626 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
9627 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
9628 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
9629 the die. */
9630 if (emit_name_p)
9631 {
9632 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
9633 gcc_assert (name);
9634 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
9635 }
9636
9637 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
9638 {
9639 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
9640 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
9641 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
9642 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
9643 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
9644 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
9645 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type, 0,
9646 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type),
9647 parent_die);
9648 }
9649 else
9650 {
9651 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
9652 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
9653 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
9654
9655 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
9656 to the name of the argument. */
9657 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
9658 if (name)
9659 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
9660 }
9661
9662 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
9663 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
9664 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
9665 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
9666 of ARG.
9667 We must be careful here:
9668 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
9669 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
9670 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
9671 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
9672 emitted after cgraph computations.
9673 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
9674 after cgraph is ready. */
9675 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
9676 }
9677
9678 return tmpl_die;
9679 }
9680
9681 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
9682 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
9683 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
9684
9685 static dw_die_ref
9686 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
9687 tree parm_pack_args,
9688 dw_die_ref parent_die)
9689 {
9690 dw_die_ref die;
9691 int j;
9692
9693 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
9694
9695 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
9696 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
9697 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
9698 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
9699 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
9700 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
9701 die);
9702 return die;
9703 }
9704
9705 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
9706 an enumerated type. */
9707
9708 static inline int
9709 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
9710 {
9711 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
9712 }
9713
9714 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
9715
9716 static unsigned int
9717 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
9718 {
9719 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
9720
9721 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
9722
9723 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
9724 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
9725 {
9726 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
9727 if (leaf_reg != -1)
9728 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
9729 }
9730 #endif
9731
9732 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
9733 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
9734 return regno;
9735 }
9736
9737 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
9738 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
9739 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
9740
9741 static void
9742 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
9743 {
9744 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
9745
9746 if (*list_head != NULL)
9747 {
9748 /* Find the end of the chain. */
9749 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
9750 ;
9751
9752 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
9753 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
9754 }
9755 }
9756
9757 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
9758 zero if there is none. */
9759
9760 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9761 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
9762 {
9763 rtx regs;
9764
9765 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
9766 return 0;
9767
9768 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
9769 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
9770 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
9771 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
9772 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
9773 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
9774 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
9775 {
9776 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
9777
9778 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
9779 {
9780 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
9781 initialized);
9782 if (result)
9783 add_loc_descr (&result,
9784 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
9785 }
9786 return result;
9787 }
9788
9789 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
9790
9791 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
9792 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
9793 else
9794 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
9795 }
9796
9797 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
9798 a given hard register number. */
9799
9800 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9801 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
9802 {
9803 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
9804
9805 if (regno <= 31)
9806 reg_loc_descr
9807 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
9808 else
9809 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
9810
9811 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9812 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9813
9814 return reg_loc_descr;
9815 }
9816
9817 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
9818 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
9819
9820 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9821 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
9822 enum var_init_status initialized)
9823 {
9824 int nregs, size, i;
9825 unsigned reg;
9826 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9827
9828 reg = REGNO (rtl);
9829 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
9830 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
9831 {
9832 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
9833 if (leaf_reg != -1)
9834 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
9835 }
9836 #endif
9837 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
9838 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
9839
9840 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
9841 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
9842 {
9843 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
9844
9845 loc_result = NULL;
9846 while (nregs--)
9847 {
9848 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
9849
9850 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
9851 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9852 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
9853 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
9854 ++reg;
9855 }
9856 return loc_result;
9857 }
9858
9859 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
9860
9861 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
9862
9863 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
9864 loc_result = NULL;
9865
9866 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
9867 {
9868 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
9869
9870 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
9871 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9872 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
9873 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
9874 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
9875 }
9876
9877 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9878 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9879 return loc_result;
9880 }
9881
9882 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9883
9884 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
9885 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
9886 and DW_OP_shl. */
9887
9888 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9889 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
9890 {
9891 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
9892 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
9893 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
9894 return ret;
9895 }
9896
9897 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
9898
9899 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9900 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
9901 {
9902 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9903
9904 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
9905 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
9906 if (i >= 0)
9907 {
9908 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
9909 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
9910 if (i <= 31)
9911 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
9912 else if (i <= 0xff)
9913 op = DW_OP_const1u;
9914 else if (i <= 0xffff)
9915 op = DW_OP_const2u;
9916 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
9917 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9918 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
9919 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
9920 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
9921 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
9922 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
9923 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9924 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
9925 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
9926 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
9927 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
9928 op = DW_OP_const4u;
9929 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
9930 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9931 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
9932 while DW_OP_constu of constant >= 0x100000000 takes at least
9933 6 bytes. */
9934 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
9935 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
9936 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
9937 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9938 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
9939 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes,
9940 while DW_OP_constu takes in this case at least 6 bytes. */
9941 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
9942 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
9943 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9944 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
9945 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
9946 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
9947 else
9948 op = DW_OP_constu;
9949 }
9950 else
9951 {
9952 if (i >= -0x80)
9953 op = DW_OP_const1s;
9954 else if (i >= -0x8000)
9955 op = DW_OP_const2s;
9956 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
9957 {
9958 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
9959 {
9960 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
9961 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
9962 return ret;
9963 }
9964 op = DW_OP_const4s;
9965 }
9966 else
9967 {
9968 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
9969 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
9970 {
9971 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
9972 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
9973 return ret;
9974 }
9975 op = DW_OP_consts;
9976 }
9977 }
9978
9979 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
9980 }
9981
9982 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
9983 without actually allocating it. */
9984
9985 static unsigned long
9986 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
9987 {
9988 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
9989 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
9990 + 1;
9991 }
9992
9993 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
9994 actually allocating it. */
9995
9996 static unsigned long
9997 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
9998 {
9999 unsigned long s;
10000
10001 if (i >= 0)
10002 {
10003 int clz, ctz;
10004 if (i <= 31)
10005 return 1;
10006 else if (i <= 0xff)
10007 return 2;
10008 else if (i <= 0xffff)
10009 return 3;
10010 clz = clz_hwi (i);
10011 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
10012 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
10013 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10014 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10015 - clz - 5);
10016 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
10017 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10018 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10019 - clz - 8);
10020 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
10021 return 5;
10022 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
10023 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
10024 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10025 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10026 - clz - 8);
10027 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
10028 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10029 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10030 - clz - 16);
10031 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
10032 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10033 && s > 6)
10034 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10035 - clz - 32);
10036 else
10037 return 1 + s;
10038 }
10039 else
10040 {
10041 if (i >= -0x80)
10042 return 2;
10043 else if (i >= -0x8000)
10044 return 3;
10045 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
10046 {
10047 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
10048 {
10049 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
10050 if (s < 5)
10051 return s;
10052 }
10053 return 5;
10054 }
10055 else
10056 {
10057 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
10058 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
10059 {
10060 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
10061 if (s < r)
10062 return s;
10063 }
10064 return r;
10065 }
10066 }
10067 }
10068
10069 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
10070 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
10071
10072 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10073 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
10074 {
10075 int litsize;
10076 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
10077
10078 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
10079 return NULL;
10080
10081 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
10082 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
10083 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
10084 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
10085 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
10086 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
10087 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
10088 {
10089 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
10090 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
10091 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
10092 return loc_result;
10093 }
10094
10095 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
10096 size, 0);
10097 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
10098 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
10099 return loc_result;
10100 }
10101
10102 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
10103
10104 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10105 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
10106 enum var_init_status initialized)
10107 {
10108 unsigned int regno;
10109 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
10110 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
10111
10112 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
10113 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
10114 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
10115 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
10116 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
10117 {
10118 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10119
10120 if (elim != reg)
10121 {
10122 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10123 {
10124 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10125 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10126 }
10127 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
10128 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10129 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
10130 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
10131 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10132 : stack_pointer_rtx));
10133
10134 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
10135 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
10136 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
10137 access stack variables. */
10138 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
10139 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
10140 {
10141 int base_reg
10142 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
10143 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10144 : REGNO (elim));
10145 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
10146 }
10147
10148 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
10149 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
10150 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
10151 }
10152 }
10153
10154 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
10155
10156 if (!optimize && fde
10157 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno))
10158 {
10159 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
10160 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
10161 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
10162 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
10163 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
10164 else in other part of the routine. */
10165 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
10166 }
10167
10168 if (regno <= 31)
10169 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
10170 offset, 0);
10171 else
10172 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
10173
10174 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
10175 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
10176
10177 return result;
10178 }
10179
10180 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
10181
10182 static inline int
10183 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
10184 {
10185 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
10186 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10187 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
10188 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
10189 }
10190
10191 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
10192 failed. */
10193
10194 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10195 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
10196 {
10197 tree base;
10198 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
10199
10200 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
10201 return NULL;
10202
10203 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
10204 if (base == NULL
10205 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
10206 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
10207 return NULL;
10208
10209 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1);
10210 if (loc_result == NULL)
10211 return NULL;
10212
10213 if (MEM_OFFSET (mem))
10214 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
10215
10216 return loc_result;
10217 }
10218
10219 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
10220 expression. */
10221
10222 static void
10223 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
10224 {
10225 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10226 {
10227 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
10228 if (expr)
10229 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
10230 if (rtl)
10231 {
10232 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
10233 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
10234 }
10235 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
10236 }
10237 }
10238
10239 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output, called either directly
10240 or via for_each_rtx. */
10241
10242 static int
10243 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx *rtlp, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10244 {
10245 rtx rtl = *rtlp;
10246
10247 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
10248 {
10249 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
10250 we can't express it in the debug info. */
10251 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
10252 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
10253 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
10254 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
10255 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
10256 if (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
10257 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
10258 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE)
10259 inform (current_function_decl
10260 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
10261 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
10262 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
10263 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
10264 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
10265 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
10266 XINT (rtl, 1));
10267 #else
10268 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
10269 XINT (rtl, 1));
10270 #endif
10271 #endif
10272 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
10273 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
10274 return 1;
10275 }
10276
10277 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
10278 {
10279 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
10280 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
10281 return 1;
10282 }
10283
10284 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
10285 return 0;
10286
10287 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
10288 {
10289 bool marked;
10290 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
10291 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
10292 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
10293 if (!marked)
10294 {
10295 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
10296 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
10297 return 1;
10298 }
10299 }
10300
10301 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
10302 return 1;
10303
10304 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
10305 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
10306 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
10307 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
10308 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
10309 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
10310 {
10311 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
10312
10313 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
10314 {
10315 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
10316 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
10317 return 1;
10318 }
10319 }
10320
10321 return 0;
10322 }
10323
10324 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
10325 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
10326 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
10327
10328 static bool
10329 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
10330 {
10331 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
10332 return const_ok_for_output_1 (&rtl, NULL) == 0;
10333
10334 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
10335 return for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), const_ok_for_output_1, NULL) == 0;
10336
10337 return true;
10338 }
10339
10340 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
10341 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
10342
10343 static dw_die_ref
10344 base_type_for_mode (enum machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
10345 {
10346 dw_die_ref type_die;
10347 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
10348
10349 if (type == NULL)
10350 return NULL;
10351 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
10352 {
10353 case INTEGER_TYPE:
10354 case REAL_TYPE:
10355 break;
10356 default:
10357 return NULL;
10358 }
10359 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
10360 if (!type_die)
10361 type_die = modified_type_die (type, false, false, comp_unit_die ());
10362 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
10363 return NULL;
10364 return type_die;
10365 }
10366
10367 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
10368 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
10369 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
10370 possible. */
10371
10372 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10373 convert_descriptor_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
10374 {
10375 enum machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
10376 dw_die_ref type_die;
10377 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
10378
10379 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10380 {
10381 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0));
10382 return op;
10383 }
10384 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
10385 if (type_die == NULL)
10386 return NULL;
10387 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10388 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10389 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10390 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10391 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
10392 return op;
10393 }
10394
10395 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
10396
10397 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10398 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
10399 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
10400 {
10401 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
10402 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
10403 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
10404 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
10405 {
10406 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
10407 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
10408 }
10409 return ret;
10410 }
10411
10412 /* Return location descriptor for signed comparison OP RTL. */
10413
10414 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10415 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
10416 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10417 {
10418 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
10419 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
10420 int shift;
10421
10422 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
10423 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
10424 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
10425 return NULL;
10426
10427 if (dwarf_strict
10428 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
10429 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
10430 return NULL;
10431
10432 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
10433 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10434 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
10435 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10436
10437 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
10438 return NULL;
10439
10440 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
10441 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10442 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
10443
10444 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10445 {
10446 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
10447 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
10448
10449 if (type_die == NULL)
10450 return NULL;
10451 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10452 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10453 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10454 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10455 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
10456 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10457 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10458 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10459 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10460 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
10461 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
10462 }
10463
10464 shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10465 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
10466 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
10467 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
10468 {
10469 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
10470 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
10471 ;
10472 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
10473 ;
10474 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
10475 whether they are zero extended or not. */
10476 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
10477 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
10478 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10479 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10480 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
10481 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
10482 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
10483 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
10484 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
10485 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
10486 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
10487
10488 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
10489 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
10490 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
10491 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
10492 or
10493 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
10494 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
10495 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
10496 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10497 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
10498 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
10499 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
10500 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
10501 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
10502 {
10503 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
10504 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10505 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
10506 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
10507 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
10508 }
10509 }
10510 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
10511 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
10512 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
10513 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
10514 else
10515 {
10516 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
10517 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
10518 }
10519 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
10520 }
10521
10522 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
10523
10524 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10525 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
10526 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10527 {
10528 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
10529 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
10530
10531 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
10532 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
10533 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
10534 return NULL;
10535 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
10536 return NULL;
10537
10538 if (dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10539 return NULL;
10540
10541 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
10542 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10543 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
10544 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10545
10546 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
10547 return NULL;
10548
10549 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10550 {
10551 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
10552 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
10553 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
10554 ;
10555 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
10556 ;
10557 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10558 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
10559 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
10560 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
10561 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
10562 {
10563 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
10564 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10565 }
10566 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
10567 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
10568 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
10569 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
10570 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
10571 {
10572 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
10573 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10574 }
10575 }
10576 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10577 {
10578 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
10579 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
10580 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
10581 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
10582 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
10583 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
10584 else
10585 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
10586 bias, 0));
10587 }
10588 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
10589 }
10590
10591 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
10592
10593 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10594 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
10595 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10596 {
10597 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
10598 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
10599 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
10600
10601 if (dwarf_strict
10602 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
10603 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
10604 return NULL;
10605
10606 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
10607 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10608 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
10609 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10610
10611 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
10612 return NULL;
10613
10614 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
10615 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10616 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
10617 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
10618 {
10619 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10620 {
10621 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
10622 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
10623 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10624 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
10625 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10626 }
10627 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10628 {
10629 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
10630 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
10631 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
10632 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
10633 }
10634 }
10635 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
10636 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10637 {
10638 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10639 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
10640 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
10641 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
10642 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
10643 }
10644 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
10645 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10646 {
10647 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
10648 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
10649 if (type_die == NULL)
10650 return NULL;
10651 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10652 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10653 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10654 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10655 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
10656 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10657 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10658 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10659 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10660 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
10661 }
10662
10663 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
10664 op = DW_OP_lt;
10665 else
10666 op = DW_OP_gt;
10667 ret = op0;
10668 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
10669 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
10670 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
10671 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
10672 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10673 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
10674 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
10675 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10676 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
10677 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
10678 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
10679 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10680 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, ret);
10681 return ret;
10682 }
10683
10684 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
10685 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
10686 convert back to unsigned. */
10687
10688 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10689 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
10690 enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10691 {
10692 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
10693
10694 if (type_die == NULL)
10695 return NULL;
10696 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
10697 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10698 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
10699 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10700 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
10701 return NULL;
10702 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10703 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10704 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10705 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10706 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
10707 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
10708 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
10709 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
10710 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
10711 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
10712 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
10713 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
10714 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
10715 }
10716
10717 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
10718 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
10719 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
10720 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
10721 for the mode):
10722 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
10723 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
10724 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
10725 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
10726 L3: DW_OP_drop
10727 L4: DW_OP_nop
10728
10729 CTZ is similar:
10730 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
10731 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
10732 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
10733 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
10734 L3: DW_OP_drop
10735 L4: DW_OP_nop
10736
10737 FFS is similar:
10738 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
10739 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
10740 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
10741 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
10742 L3: DW_OP_drop
10743 L4: DW_OP_nop */
10744
10745 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10746 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
10747 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10748 {
10749 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
10750 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
10751 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
10752 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
10753 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
10754 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
10755 rtx msb;
10756
10757 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
10758 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode
10759 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
10760 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
10761 return NULL;
10762
10763 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
10764 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10765 if (op0 == NULL)
10766 return NULL;
10767 ret = op0;
10768 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
10769 {
10770 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
10771 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
10772 }
10773 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
10774 valv = 0;
10775 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
10776 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
10777 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
10778 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
10779 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
10780 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
10781 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
10782 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10783 if (tmp == NULL)
10784 return NULL;
10785 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10786 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
10787 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
10788 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
10789 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
10790 mode, mem_mode,
10791 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10792 if (l1label == NULL)
10793 return NULL;
10794 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
10795 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10796 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
10797 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
10798 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
10799 msb = const1_rtx;
10800 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10801 msb = GEN_INT ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10802 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
10803 else
10804 msb = immed_double_const (0, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10805 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
10806 - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1), mode);
10807 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
10808 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
10809 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
10810 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
10811 else
10812 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
10813 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10814 if (tmp == NULL)
10815 return NULL;
10816 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10817 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10818 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
10819 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
10820 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
10821 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10822 if (tmp == NULL)
10823 return NULL;
10824 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10825 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
10826 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
10827 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10828 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
10829 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10830 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
10831 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
10832 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
10833 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
10834 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
10835 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
10836 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10837 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
10838 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10839 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
10840 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10841 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
10842 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10843 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
10844 return ret;
10845 }
10846
10847 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
10848 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
10849 const0 DW_OP_swap
10850 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
10851 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
10852 L2: DW_OP_drop
10853
10854 PARITY is similar:
10855 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
10856 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
10857 L2: DW_OP_drop */
10858
10859 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10860 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
10861 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10862 {
10863 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
10864 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
10865 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
10866
10867 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
10868 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
10869 return NULL;
10870
10871 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
10872 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10873 if (op0 == NULL)
10874 return NULL;
10875 ret = op0;
10876 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
10877 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10878 if (tmp == NULL)
10879 return NULL;
10880 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10881 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10882 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
10883 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
10884 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
10885 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
10886 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
10887 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
10888 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
10889 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10890 if (tmp == NULL)
10891 return NULL;
10892 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10893 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10894 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
10895 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
10896 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10897 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
10898 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10899 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10900 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
10901 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
10902 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
10903 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
10904 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
10905 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10906 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
10907 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10908 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
10909 return ret;
10910 }
10911
10912 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
10913 constS const0
10914 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
10915 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
10916 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
10917 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
10918 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
10919
10920 static dw_loc_descr_ref
10921 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
10922 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
10923 {
10924 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
10925 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
10926 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
10927
10928 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
10929 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
10930 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
10931 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
10932 return NULL;
10933
10934 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
10935 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10936 if (op0 == NULL)
10937 return NULL;
10938
10939 ret = op0;
10940 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
10941 mode, mem_mode,
10942 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10943 if (tmp == NULL)
10944 return NULL;
10945 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10946 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
10947 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10948 if (tmp == NULL)
10949 return NULL;
10950 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10951 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
10952 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
10953 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
10954 mode, mem_mode,
10955 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10956 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10957 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
10958 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
10959 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
10960 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
10961 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10962 if (tmp == NULL)
10963 return NULL;
10964 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10965 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
10966 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
10967 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
10968 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
10969 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10970 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
10971 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
10972 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10973 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10974 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
10975 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
10976 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
10977 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
10978 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
10979 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
10980 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
10981 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10982 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
10983 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
10984 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
10985 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
10986 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
10987 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
10988 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10989 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
10990 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
10991 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
10992 return ret;
10993 }
10994
10995 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
10996 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
10997 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
10998 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
10999
11000 ROTATERT is similar:
11001 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
11002 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
11003 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
11004
11005 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11006 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
11007 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
11008 {
11009 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
11010 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
11011 int i;
11012
11013 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
11014 return NULL;
11015
11016 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
11017 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
11018 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
11019 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11020 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11021 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
11022 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11023 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
11024 return NULL;
11025 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11026 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11027 {
11028 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11029 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
11030 mode, mem_mode,
11031 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11032 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11033 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
11034 ? DW_OP_const4u
11035 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
11036 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
11037 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
11038 else
11039 mask[i] = NULL;
11040 if (mask[i] == NULL)
11041 return NULL;
11042 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
11043 }
11044 ret = op0;
11045 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
11046 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
11047 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
11048 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
11049 {
11050 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11051 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
11052 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
11053 }
11054 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11055 if (mask[0] != NULL)
11056 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
11057 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
11058 if (mask[1] != NULL)
11059 {
11060 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
11061 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
11062 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
11063 }
11064 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
11065 {
11066 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11067 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
11068 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
11069 }
11070 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
11071 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
11072 return ret;
11073 }
11074
11075 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
11076 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
11077
11078 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11079 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
11080 {
11081 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
11082 dw_die_ref ref;
11083
11084 if (dwarf_strict)
11085 return NULL;
11086 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
11087 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
11088 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
11089 if (ref)
11090 {
11091 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11092 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
11093 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11094 }
11095 else
11096 {
11097 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
11098 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
11099 }
11100 return ret;
11101 }
11102
11103 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
11104 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
11105 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
11106 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
11107
11108 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
11109 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
11110 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
11111 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
11112
11113 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
11114
11115 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
11116 autoincrement addressing modes.
11117
11118 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
11119
11120 dw_loc_descr_ref
11121 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
11122 enum machine_mode mem_mode,
11123 enum var_init_status initialized)
11124 {
11125 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
11126 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
11127 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
11128
11129 if (mode == VOIDmode)
11130 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
11131
11132 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
11133 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
11134 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
11135 zeroth element of the array. */
11136
11137 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
11138
11139 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
11140 return NULL;
11141
11142 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
11143 {
11144 case POST_INC:
11145 case POST_DEC:
11146 case POST_MODIFY:
11147 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
11148
11149 case SUBREG:
11150 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
11151 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
11152 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
11153 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
11154 contains the given subreg. */
11155 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
11156 break;
11157 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
11158 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))) == MODE_INT
11159 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11160 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
11161 || (mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
11162 #endif
11163 )
11164 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11165 {
11166 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
11167 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)),
11168 mem_mode, initialized);
11169 break;
11170 }
11171 if (dwarf_strict)
11172 break;
11173 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))))
11174 break;
11175 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)))
11176 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
11177 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))) != MODE_INT))
11178 break;
11179 else
11180 {
11181 dw_die_ref type_die;
11182 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
11183
11184 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
11185 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)),
11186 mem_mode, initialized);
11187 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
11188 break;
11189 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
11190 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
11191 if (type_die == NULL)
11192 {
11193 mem_loc_result = NULL;
11194 break;
11195 }
11196 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
11197 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))))
11198 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11199 else
11200 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret, 0, 0);
11201 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11202 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11203 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11204 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
11205 }
11206 break;
11207
11208 case REG:
11209 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
11210 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11211 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
11212 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
11213 #endif
11214 ))
11215 {
11216 dw_die_ref type_die;
11217
11218 if (dwarf_strict)
11219 break;
11220 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11221 break;
11222 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
11223 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
11224 if (type_die == NULL)
11225 break;
11226 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_regval_type,
11227 dbx_reg_number (rtl), 0);
11228 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11229 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11230 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11231 break;
11232 }
11233 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
11234 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
11235 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
11236 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
11237 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
11238 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
11239 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
11240 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
11241 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
11242 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
11243 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
11244 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
11245 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
11246 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11247 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11248 else if (stack_realign_drap
11249 && crtl->drap_reg
11250 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
11251 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11252 {
11253 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
11254 out, use DRAP instead. */
11255 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
11256 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11257 }
11258 break;
11259
11260 case SIGN_EXTEND:
11261 case ZERO_EXTEND:
11262 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
11263 break;
11264 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
11265 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11266 if (op0 == 0)
11267 break;
11268 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
11269 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11270 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
11271 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11272 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
11273 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
11274 masking. */
11275 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= 4)
11276 {
11277 enum machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
11278 mem_loc_result = op0;
11279 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
11280 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (imode)));
11281 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
11282 }
11283 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11284 {
11285 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11286 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
11287 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
11288 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
11289 op = DW_OP_shra;
11290 else
11291 op = DW_OP_shr;
11292 mem_loc_result = op0;
11293 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11294 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11295 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11296 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11297 }
11298 else if (!dwarf_strict)
11299 {
11300 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
11301 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
11302
11303 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
11304 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
11305 if (type_die1 == NULL)
11306 break;
11307 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
11308 if (type_die2 == NULL)
11309 break;
11310 mem_loc_result = op0;
11311 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11312 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11313 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
11314 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11315 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
11316 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11317 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11318 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
11319 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11320 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
11321 }
11322 break;
11323
11324 case MEM:
11325 {
11326 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
11327 if (new_rtl != rtl)
11328 {
11329 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
11330 initialized);
11331 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
11332 return mem_loc_result;
11333 }
11334 }
11335 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
11336 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
11337 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11338 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
11339 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
11340 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
11341 {
11342 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11343 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
11344 {
11345 dw_die_ref type_die;
11346 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
11347
11348 if (dwarf_strict)
11349 return NULL;
11350 type_die
11351 = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
11352 if (type_die == NULL)
11353 return NULL;
11354 deref = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_deref_type,
11355 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
11356 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11357 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11358 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11359 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
11360 }
11361 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11362 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
11363 else
11364 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
11365 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
11366 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
11367 }
11368 break;
11369
11370 case LO_SUM:
11371 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
11372
11373 case LABEL_REF:
11374 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
11375 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
11376 pool. */
11377 case CONST:
11378 case SYMBOL_REF:
11379 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
11380 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11381 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
11382 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
11383 #endif
11384 ))
11385 break;
11386 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
11387 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
11388 {
11389 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
11390
11391 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
11392 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
11393 break;
11394
11395 /* We used to emit DW_OP_addr here, but that's wrong, since
11396 DW_OP_addr should be relocated by the debug info consumer,
11397 while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address operand should not. */
11398 temp = new_loc_descr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4
11399 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u, 0, 0);
11400 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
11401 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
11402 temp->dtprel = true;
11403
11404 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
11405 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
11406
11407 break;
11408 }
11409
11410 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
11411 break;
11412
11413 symref:
11414 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
11415 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
11416 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
11417 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
11418 break;
11419
11420 case CONCAT:
11421 case CONCATN:
11422 case VAR_LOCATION:
11423 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
11424 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
11425 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
11426 return 0;
11427
11428 case ENTRY_VALUE:
11429 if (dwarf_strict)
11430 return NULL;
11431 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
11432 {
11433 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
11434 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11435 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
11436 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11437 else
11438 op0
11439 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)),
11440 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11441 }
11442 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
11443 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
11444 {
11445 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
11446 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11447 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
11448 return NULL;
11449 }
11450 else
11451 gcc_unreachable ();
11452 if (op0 == NULL)
11453 return NULL;
11454 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value, 0, 0);
11455 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
11456 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
11457 break;
11458
11459 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
11460 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
11461 break;
11462
11463 case PRE_MODIFY:
11464 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
11465 PLUS code below. */
11466 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
11467 goto plus;
11468
11469 case PRE_INC:
11470 case PRE_DEC:
11471 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
11472 below. */
11473 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
11474 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
11475 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
11476 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)));
11477
11478 /* ... fall through ... */
11479
11480 case PLUS:
11481 plus:
11482 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
11483 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11484 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
11485 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
11486 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
11487 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11488 else
11489 {
11490 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11491 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11492 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
11493 break;
11494
11495 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11496 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11497 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
11498 else
11499 {
11500 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
11501 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11502 if (op1 == 0)
11503 break;
11504 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
11505 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
11506 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
11507 }
11508 }
11509 break;
11510
11511 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
11512 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
11513 case MINUS:
11514 op = DW_OP_minus;
11515 goto do_binop;
11516
11517 case MULT:
11518 op = DW_OP_mul;
11519 goto do_binop;
11520
11521 case DIV:
11522 if (!dwarf_strict
11523 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
11524 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11525 {
11526 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
11527 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
11528 mode, mem_mode);
11529 break;
11530 }
11531 op = DW_OP_div;
11532 goto do_binop;
11533
11534 case UMOD:
11535 op = DW_OP_mod;
11536 goto do_binop;
11537
11538 case ASHIFT:
11539 op = DW_OP_shl;
11540 goto do_shift;
11541
11542 case ASHIFTRT:
11543 op = DW_OP_shra;
11544 goto do_shift;
11545
11546 case LSHIFTRT:
11547 op = DW_OP_shr;
11548 goto do_shift;
11549
11550 do_shift:
11551 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
11552 break;
11553 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11554 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11555 {
11556 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
11557 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
11558 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1))
11559 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
11560 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
11561 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
11562 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11563 }
11564
11565 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
11566 break;
11567
11568 mem_loc_result = op0;
11569 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
11570 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11571 break;
11572
11573 case AND:
11574 op = DW_OP_and;
11575 goto do_binop;
11576
11577 case IOR:
11578 op = DW_OP_or;
11579 goto do_binop;
11580
11581 case XOR:
11582 op = DW_OP_xor;
11583 goto do_binop;
11584
11585 do_binop:
11586 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11587 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11588 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
11589 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11590
11591 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
11592 break;
11593
11594 mem_loc_result = op0;
11595 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
11596 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11597 break;
11598
11599 case MOD:
11600 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE && !dwarf_strict)
11601 {
11602 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
11603 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
11604 mode, mem_mode);
11605 break;
11606 }
11607
11608 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11609 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11610 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
11611 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11612
11613 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
11614 break;
11615
11616 mem_loc_result = op0;
11617 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
11618 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
11619 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
11620 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
11621 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
11622 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
11623 break;
11624
11625 case UDIV:
11626 if (!dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
11627 {
11628 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11629 {
11630 op = DW_OP_div;
11631 goto do_binop;
11632 }
11633 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
11634 base_type_for_mode (mode, 1),
11635 mode, mem_mode);
11636 }
11637 break;
11638
11639 case NOT:
11640 op = DW_OP_not;
11641 goto do_unop;
11642
11643 case ABS:
11644 op = DW_OP_abs;
11645 goto do_unop;
11646
11647 case NEG:
11648 op = DW_OP_neg;
11649 goto do_unop;
11650
11651 do_unop:
11652 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11653 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11654
11655 if (op0 == 0)
11656 break;
11657
11658 mem_loc_result = op0;
11659 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11660 break;
11661
11662 case CONST_INT:
11663 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11664 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
11665 || (mode == Pmode
11666 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
11667 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
11668 #endif
11669 )
11670 {
11671 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
11672 break;
11673 }
11674 if (!dwarf_strict
11675 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11676 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
11677 {
11678 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
11679 enum machine_mode amode;
11680 if (type_die == NULL)
11681 return NULL;
11682 amode = mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT,
11683 MODE_INT, 0);
11684 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
11685 && amode != BLKmode
11686 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
11687 /* const DW_OP_GNU_convert <XXX> vs.
11688 DW_OP_GNU_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
11689 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
11690 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
11691 {
11692 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
11693 op0 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11694 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11695 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11696 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11697 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
11698 return mem_loc_result;
11699 }
11700 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0,
11701 INTVAL (rtl));
11702 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11703 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11704 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11705 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11706 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
11707 else
11708 {
11709 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
11710 = dw_val_class_const_double;
11711 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
11712 = shwi_to_double_int (INTVAL (rtl));
11713 }
11714 }
11715 break;
11716
11717 case CONST_DOUBLE:
11718 if (!dwarf_strict)
11719 {
11720 dw_die_ref type_die;
11721
11722 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
11723 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
11724 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
11725 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
11726 if (mode == VOIDmode
11727 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
11728 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
11729 break;
11730 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
11731 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
11732 if (type_die == NULL)
11733 return NULL;
11734 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
11735 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11736 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11737 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11738 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
11739 {
11740 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
11741 unsigned char *array
11742 = (unsigned char*) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
11743
11744 insert_float (rtl, array);
11745 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
11746 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
11747 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
11748 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
11749 }
11750 else
11751 {
11752 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
11753 = dw_val_class_const_double;
11754 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
11755 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
11756 }
11757 }
11758 break;
11759
11760 case EQ:
11761 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
11762 break;
11763
11764 case GE:
11765 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
11766 break;
11767
11768 case GT:
11769 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
11770 break;
11771
11772 case LE:
11773 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
11774 break;
11775
11776 case LT:
11777 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
11778 break;
11779
11780 case NE:
11781 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
11782 break;
11783
11784 case GEU:
11785 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
11786 break;
11787
11788 case GTU:
11789 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
11790 break;
11791
11792 case LEU:
11793 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
11794 break;
11795
11796 case LTU:
11797 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
11798 break;
11799
11800 case UMIN:
11801 case UMAX:
11802 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
11803 break;
11804 /* FALLTHRU */
11805 case SMIN:
11806 case SMAX:
11807 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
11808 break;
11809
11810 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
11811 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
11812 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11813 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
11814 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11815 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
11816 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
11817 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
11818 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11819 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11820 {
11821 int shift, size;
11822 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
11823 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11824 if (op0 == 0)
11825 break;
11826 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
11827 op = DW_OP_shra;
11828 else
11829 op = DW_OP_shr;
11830 mem_loc_result = op0;
11831 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
11832 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
11833 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
11834 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
11835 - shift - size;
11836 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11837 {
11838 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
11839 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11840 - shift - size));
11841 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11842 }
11843 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11844 {
11845 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
11846 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
11847 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11848 }
11849 }
11850 break;
11851
11852 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
11853 {
11854 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
11855 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
11856 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
11857 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
11858 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11859 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
11860 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11861 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
11862 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11863 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
11864 break;
11865
11866 mem_loc_result = op1;
11867 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
11868 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
11869 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
11870 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
11871 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
11872 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
11873 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
11874 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
11875 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
11876 }
11877 break;
11878
11879 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
11880 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
11881 case FLOAT:
11882 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
11883 case FIX:
11884 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
11885 if (!dwarf_strict)
11886 {
11887 dw_die_ref type_die;
11888 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
11889
11890 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
11891 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11892 if (op0 == NULL)
11893 break;
11894 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) == MODE_INT
11895 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
11896 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
11897 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
11898 {
11899 type_die = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
11900 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
11901 if (type_die == NULL)
11902 break;
11903 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11904 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11905 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11906 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11907 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
11908 }
11909 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
11910 if (type_die == NULL)
11911 break;
11912 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11913 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11914 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11915 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11916 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
11917 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
11918 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
11919 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
11920 {
11921 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
11922 if (op0 == NULL)
11923 break;
11924 }
11925 mem_loc_result = op0;
11926 }
11927 break;
11928
11929 case CLZ:
11930 case CTZ:
11931 case FFS:
11932 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
11933 break;
11934
11935 case POPCOUNT:
11936 case PARITY:
11937 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
11938 break;
11939
11940 case BSWAP:
11941 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
11942 break;
11943
11944 case ROTATE:
11945 case ROTATERT:
11946 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
11947 break;
11948
11949 case COMPARE:
11950 case TRUNCATE:
11951 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
11952 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
11953 natively. */
11954 case SS_MULT:
11955 case US_MULT:
11956 case SS_DIV:
11957 case US_DIV:
11958 case SS_PLUS:
11959 case US_PLUS:
11960 case SS_MINUS:
11961 case US_MINUS:
11962 case SS_NEG:
11963 case US_NEG:
11964 case SS_ABS:
11965 case SS_ASHIFT:
11966 case US_ASHIFT:
11967 case SS_TRUNCATE:
11968 case US_TRUNCATE:
11969 case UNORDERED:
11970 case ORDERED:
11971 case UNEQ:
11972 case UNGE:
11973 case UNGT:
11974 case UNLE:
11975 case UNLT:
11976 case LTGT:
11977 case FRACT_CONVERT:
11978 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
11979 case SAT_FRACT:
11980 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
11981 case SQRT:
11982 case ASM_OPERANDS:
11983 case VEC_MERGE:
11984 case VEC_SELECT:
11985 case VEC_CONCAT:
11986 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
11987 case UNSPEC:
11988 case HIGH:
11989 case FMA:
11990 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
11991 case CONST_VECTOR:
11992 case CONST_FIXED:
11993 case CLRSB:
11994 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
11995 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
11996 TLS UNSPECs. */
11997 break;
11998
11999 case CONST_STRING:
12000 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
12001 goto symref;
12002
12003 default:
12004 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
12005 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
12006 gcc_unreachable ();
12007 #else
12008 break;
12009 #endif
12010 }
12011
12012 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12013 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12014
12015 return mem_loc_result;
12016 }
12017
12018 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
12019 This is typically a complex variable. */
12020
12021 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12022 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
12023 {
12024 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
12025 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
12026 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12027 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
12028 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12029
12030 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
12031 return 0;
12032
12033 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
12034 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
12035
12036 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
12037 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
12038
12039 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12040 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12041
12042 return cc_loc_result;
12043 }
12044
12045 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
12046 locations. */
12047
12048 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12049 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
12050 {
12051 unsigned int i;
12052 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
12053 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
12054
12055 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
12056 {
12057 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
12058 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
12059
12060 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12061 if (ref == NULL)
12062 return NULL;
12063
12064 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
12065 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
12066 }
12067
12068 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12069 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12070
12071 return cc_loc_result;
12072 }
12073
12074 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
12075 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
12076
12077 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12078 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
12079 {
12080 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
12081 dw_die_ref ref;
12082
12083 if (dwarf_strict)
12084 return NULL;
12085 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
12086 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
12087 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
12088 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
12089 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
12090 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
12091 if (ref)
12092 {
12093 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12094 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
12095 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12096 }
12097 else
12098 {
12099 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
12100 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
12101 }
12102 return ret;
12103 }
12104
12105 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
12106 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
12107 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
12108 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
12109 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
12110
12111 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
12112 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
12113 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
12114
12115 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
12116
12117 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12118 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
12119 enum var_init_status initialized)
12120 {
12121 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12122
12123 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
12124 {
12125 case SUBREG:
12126 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
12127 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
12128 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
12129 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
12130 contains the given subreg. */
12131 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
12132 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
12133 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
12134 else
12135 goto do_default;
12136 break;
12137
12138 case REG:
12139 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
12140 break;
12141
12142 case MEM:
12143 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
12144 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
12145 if (loc_result == NULL)
12146 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
12147 if (loc_result == NULL)
12148 {
12149 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
12150 if (new_rtl != rtl)
12151 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
12152 }
12153 break;
12154
12155 case CONCAT:
12156 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
12157 initialized);
12158 break;
12159
12160 case CONCATN:
12161 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
12162 break;
12163
12164 case VAR_LOCATION:
12165 /* Single part. */
12166 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
12167 {
12168 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
12169 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
12170 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
12171 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
12172 break;
12173 }
12174
12175 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
12176 /* FALLTHRU */
12177
12178 case PARALLEL:
12179 {
12180 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
12181 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
12182 enum machine_mode mode;
12183 int i;
12184
12185 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
12186 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
12187 VOIDmode, initialized);
12188 if (loc_result == NULL)
12189 return NULL;
12190 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
12191 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
12192 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
12193 {
12194 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
12195
12196 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
12197 VOIDmode, initialized);
12198 if (temp == NULL)
12199 return NULL;
12200 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
12201 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
12202 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
12203 }
12204 }
12205 break;
12206
12207 case CONST_INT:
12208 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
12209 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
12210 INTVAL (rtl));
12211 break;
12212
12213 case CONST_DOUBLE:
12214 if (mode == VOIDmode)
12215 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
12216
12217 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12218 {
12219 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
12220
12221 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
12222 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
12223 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
12224 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
12225 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
12226 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
12227 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
12228 {
12229 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
12230 unsigned char *array
12231 = (unsigned char*) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
12232
12233 insert_float (rtl, array);
12234 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
12235 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
12236 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
12237 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
12238 }
12239 else
12240 {
12241 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
12242 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
12243 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
12244 }
12245 }
12246 break;
12247
12248 case CONST_VECTOR:
12249 if (mode == VOIDmode)
12250 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
12251
12252 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12253 {
12254 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
12255 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
12256 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
12257 ggc_alloc_atomic (length * elt_size);
12258 unsigned int i;
12259 unsigned char *p;
12260
12261 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
12262 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
12263 {
12264 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
12265 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
12266 {
12267 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
12268 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
12269
12270 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
12271 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
12272 else
12273 {
12274 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
12275 insert_double (val, p);
12276 }
12277 }
12278 break;
12279
12280 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
12281 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
12282 {
12283 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
12284 insert_float (elt, p);
12285 }
12286 break;
12287
12288 default:
12289 gcc_unreachable ();
12290 }
12291
12292 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
12293 length * elt_size, 0);
12294 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
12295 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
12296 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
12297 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
12298 }
12299 break;
12300
12301 case CONST:
12302 if (mode == VOIDmode
12303 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_INT
12304 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
12305 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
12306 {
12307 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
12308 break;
12309 }
12310 /* FALLTHROUGH */
12311 case SYMBOL_REF:
12312 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
12313 break;
12314 case LABEL_REF:
12315 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12316 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12317 {
12318 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
12319 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
12320 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
12321 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12322 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
12323 }
12324 break;
12325
12326 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
12327 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
12328 break;
12329
12330 case PLUS:
12331 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
12332 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12333 {
12334 loc_result
12335 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
12336 break;
12337 }
12338 /* FALLTHRU */
12339 do_default:
12340 default:
12341 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
12342 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12343 && dwarf_version >= 4)
12344 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
12345 {
12346 /* Value expression. */
12347 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
12348 if (loc_result)
12349 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
12350 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12351 }
12352 break;
12353 }
12354
12355 return loc_result;
12356 }
12357
12358 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
12359 address ranges where a given location is valid.
12360 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
12361 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
12362 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
12363 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
12364
12365 static const char *
12366 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
12367 {
12368 const char *secname;
12369
12370 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
12371 {
12372 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
12373 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
12374 }
12375 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
12376 {
12377 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
12378 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
12379 }
12380 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
12381 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
12382 else
12383 secname = text_section_label;
12384
12385 return secname;
12386 }
12387
12388 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
12389
12390 static bool
12391 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
12392 {
12393 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
12394 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
12395 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
12396 }
12397
12398 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
12399 for VARLOC. */
12400
12401 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12402 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
12403 enum var_init_status initialized)
12404 {
12405 int have_address = 0;
12406 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
12407 enum machine_mode mode;
12408
12409 if (want_address != 2)
12410 {
12411 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
12412 /* Single part. */
12413 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
12414 {
12415 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
12416 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
12417 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
12418 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
12419 if (MEM_P (varloc))
12420 {
12421 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
12422 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
12423 mode, initialized);
12424 if (descr)
12425 have_address = 1;
12426 else
12427 {
12428 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
12429 if (x != varloc)
12430 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
12431 initialized);
12432 }
12433 }
12434 else
12435 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
12436 }
12437 else
12438 return 0;
12439 }
12440 else
12441 {
12442 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
12443 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
12444 else
12445 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
12446 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
12447 have_address = 1;
12448 }
12449
12450 if (!descr)
12451 return 0;
12452
12453 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
12454 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12455 {
12456 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12457 {
12458 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
12459 "DWARF address size mismatch");
12460 return 0;
12461 }
12462 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12463 have_address = 1;
12464 }
12465 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
12466 if (want_address && !have_address)
12467 {
12468 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
12469 "Want address and only have value");
12470 return 0;
12471 }
12472
12473 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
12474 if (!want_address && have_address)
12475 {
12476 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
12477 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12478
12479 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
12480 {
12481 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
12482 "DWARF address size mismatch");
12483 return 0;
12484 }
12485 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12486 op = DW_OP_deref;
12487 else
12488 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
12489
12490 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
12491 }
12492
12493 return descr;
12494 }
12495
12496 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
12497 if it is not possible. */
12498
12499 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12500 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
12501 {
12502 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
12503 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
12504 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12505 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
12506 else
12507 return NULL;
12508 }
12509
12510 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
12511 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
12512
12513 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12514 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
12515 {
12516 rtx p;
12517 unsigned int padsize = 0;
12518 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
12519 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
12520 rtx varloc;
12521 enum var_init_status initialized;
12522
12523 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
12524 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
12525 return NULL;
12526
12527 decl_size = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1);
12528 descr = NULL;
12529 descr_tail = &descr;
12530
12531 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
12532 {
12533 unsigned int bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
12534 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
12535 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
12536 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
12537 unsigned int opsize = 0;
12538
12539 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
12540 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
12541 {
12542 padsize += bitsize;
12543 continue;
12544 }
12545 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
12546 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
12547 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
12548 if (cur_descr == NULL)
12549 {
12550 padsize += bitsize;
12551 continue;
12552 }
12553
12554 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
12555 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
12556 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
12557 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
12558 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
12559 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
12560 {
12561 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
12562 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12563 last = *tail;
12564 }
12565 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
12566 {
12567 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
12568 last = *tail;
12569 }
12570
12571 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
12572 {
12573 padsize += bitsize;
12574 continue;
12575 }
12576
12577 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
12578 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
12579 if (padsize)
12580 {
12581 if (padsize > decl_size)
12582 return NULL;
12583 decl_size -= padsize;
12584 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
12585 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
12586 return NULL;
12587 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
12588 padsize = 0;
12589 }
12590 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
12591 descr_tail = tail;
12592 if (bitsize > decl_size)
12593 return NULL;
12594 decl_size -= bitsize;
12595 if (last == NULL)
12596 {
12597 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
12598 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
12599 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
12600 {
12601 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
12602 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
12603 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
12604 }
12605 do
12606 {
12607 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
12608 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
12609 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
12610 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
12611 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
12612 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
12613 else
12614 break;
12615 }
12616 while (1);
12617 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
12618 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
12619 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
12620 adjustment. */
12621 if (MEM_P (varloc))
12622 {
12623 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
12624 = MEM_SIZE (varloc) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12625 if (memsize != bitsize)
12626 {
12627 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
12628 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
12629 return NULL;
12630 if (memsize < bitsize)
12631 return NULL;
12632 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
12633 offset = memsize - bitsize;
12634 }
12635 }
12636
12637 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
12638 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
12639 return NULL;
12640 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
12641 }
12642 }
12643
12644 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
12645 the decl. */
12646 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
12647 {
12648 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
12649 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
12650 return NULL;
12651 }
12652 return descr;
12653 }
12654
12655 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
12656 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
12657 function. */
12658
12659 static dw_loc_list_ref
12660 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
12661 {
12662 const char *endname, *secname;
12663 rtx varloc;
12664 enum var_init_status initialized;
12665 struct var_loc_node *node;
12666 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
12667 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12668 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
12669 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
12670
12671 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
12672 actually construct the list of locations.
12673 The first location information is what is passed to the
12674 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
12675 locations just get added on to that list.
12676 Note that we only know the start address for a location
12677 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
12678 the range [current location start, next location start].
12679 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
12680 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
12681
12682 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
12683
12684 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
12685 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
12686 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
12687 {
12688 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
12689 {
12690 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
12691 inside DWARF expressions. */
12692 if (want_address != 2)
12693 continue;
12694 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
12695 if (descr == NULL)
12696 continue;
12697 }
12698 else
12699 {
12700 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
12701 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
12702 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
12703 }
12704 if (descr)
12705 {
12706 bool range_across_switch = false;
12707 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
12708 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
12709 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
12710 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
12711 of first partition and second one starting at the
12712 beginning of second partition. */
12713 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
12714 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
12715 && current_function_decl)
12716 {
12717 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
12718 range_across_switch = true;
12719 }
12720 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
12721 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
12722 else if (node->next)
12723 endname = node->next->label;
12724 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
12725 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
12726 else if (!current_function_decl)
12727 endname = text_end_label;
12728 else
12729 {
12730 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
12731 current_function_funcdef_no);
12732 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
12733 }
12734
12735 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
12736 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
12737 && node == loc_list->first
12738 && GET_CODE (node->loc) == NOTE
12739 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
12740 (*listp)->force = true;
12741 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
12742
12743 if (range_across_switch)
12744 {
12745 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
12746 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
12747 else
12748 {
12749 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
12750 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
12751 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
12752 initialized);
12753 }
12754 gcc_assert (descr);
12755 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
12756 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
12757 if (node->next)
12758 endname = node->next->label;
12759 else
12760 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
12761 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
12762 cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
12763 endname, secname);
12764 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
12765 }
12766 }
12767 }
12768
12769 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
12770 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
12771 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
12772 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
12773 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
12774 available. */
12775 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
12776 gen_llsym (list);
12777
12778 return list;
12779 }
12780
12781 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
12782 as location description. */
12783
12784 static bool
12785 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
12786 {
12787 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
12788 return !list->ll_symbol;
12789 }
12790
12791 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
12792
12793 static void
12794 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
12795 {
12796 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
12797 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
12798 list = list->dw_loc_next;
12799 while (list)
12800 {
12801 copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
12802 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
12803 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
12804 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
12805 {
12806 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
12807 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
12808 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
12809 copy = new_copy;
12810 }
12811 list = list->dw_loc_next;
12812 }
12813 }
12814
12815 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
12816 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
12817 to expression in RET on each position in program.
12818 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
12819
12820 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
12821 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
12822 and merging them that will need some additional work.
12823 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
12824 structures. */
12825
12826 static void
12827 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
12828 {
12829 if (!list)
12830 return;
12831 if (!*ret)
12832 {
12833 *ret = list;
12834 return;
12835 }
12836 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
12837 {
12838 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
12839 return;
12840 }
12841 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
12842 {
12843 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
12844 *ret = list;
12845 return;
12846 }
12847 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
12848 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
12849 " location lists.\n");
12850 *ret = NULL;
12851 return;
12852 }
12853
12854 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
12855 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
12856
12857 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12858 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
12859 {
12860 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
12861 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
12862
12863 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
12864 {
12865 gcc_assert (!rtl);
12866 return 0;
12867 }
12868 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
12869
12870 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
12871 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
12872 populated. */
12873 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
12874 {
12875 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
12876 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
12877 return 0;
12878 }
12879 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
12880 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12881 }
12882
12883 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
12884 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
12885 it into simple arithmetics. */
12886
12887 static dw_loc_list_ref
12888 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev)
12889 {
12890 tree obj, offset;
12891 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
12892 enum machine_mode mode;
12893 int unsignedp, volatilep = 0;
12894 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
12895
12896 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
12897 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
12898 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
12899 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
12900 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
12901 {
12902 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
12903 return 0;
12904 }
12905 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
12906 {
12907 expansion_failed (obj,
12908 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
12909 return 0;
12910 }
12911 if (!offset && !bitpos)
12912 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1);
12913 else if (toplev
12914 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12915 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12916 {
12917 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0);
12918 if (!list_ret)
12919 return 0;
12920 if (offset)
12921 {
12922 /* Variable offset. */
12923 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
12924 if (list_ret1 == 0)
12925 return 0;
12926 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
12927 if (!list_ret)
12928 return 0;
12929 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
12930 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
12931 }
12932 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
12933 if (bytepos > 0)
12934 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
12935 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
12936 bytepos, 0));
12937 else if (bytepos < 0)
12938 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
12939 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
12940 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12941 }
12942 return list_ret;
12943 }
12944
12945
12946 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
12947 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
12948 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
12949 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
12950 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
12951 to refer to register values). */
12952
12953 static dw_loc_list_ref
12954 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
12955 {
12956 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
12957 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
12958 int have_address = 0;
12959 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12960
12961 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
12962 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
12963 problem... */
12964
12965 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
12966 {
12967 case ERROR_MARK:
12968 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
12969 return 0;
12970
12971 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
12972 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
12973 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
12974 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
12975 the names of types. */
12976 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR");
12977 return 0;
12978
12979 case CALL_EXPR:
12980 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
12981 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
12982 return 0;
12983
12984 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
12985 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
12986 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
12987 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
12988 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
12989 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
12990 return 0;
12991
12992 case ADDR_EXPR:
12993 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
12994 e.g. for &this->field. */
12995 if (want_address)
12996 {
12997 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
12998 (loc, want_address == 2);
12999 if (list_ret)
13000 have_address = 1;
13001 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
13002 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
13003 have_address = 1;
13004 }
13005 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
13006 if (!list_ret && !ret)
13007 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
13008 else
13009 {
13010 if (want_address)
13011 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
13012 return NULL;
13013 }
13014 break;
13015
13016 case VAR_DECL:
13017 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
13018 {
13019 rtx rtl;
13020 enum dwarf_location_atom first_op;
13021 enum dwarf_location_atom second_op;
13022 bool dtprel = false;
13023
13024 if (targetm.have_tls)
13025 {
13026 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
13027 data. */
13028 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13029 return 0;
13030
13031 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
13032 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
13033 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
13034 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
13035 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
13036 operand shouldn't be. */
13037 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
13038 return 0;
13039 first_op = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u;
13040 dtprel = true;
13041 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
13042 }
13043 else
13044 {
13045 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
13046 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
13047 return 0;
13048 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
13049 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
13050 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
13051 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
13052 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
13053 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
13054 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
13055 }
13056
13057 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
13058 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
13059 return 0;
13060
13061 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
13062 return 0;
13063 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
13064 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
13065 return 0;
13066
13067 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
13068 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13069 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13070 ret->dtprel = dtprel;
13071
13072 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
13073 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
13074
13075 have_address = 1;
13076 break;
13077 }
13078 /* FALLTHRU */
13079
13080 case PARM_DECL:
13081 case RESULT_DECL:
13082 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
13083 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
13084 want_address);
13085 /* FALLTHRU */
13086
13087 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13088 {
13089 rtx rtl;
13090 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
13091
13092 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
13093 {
13094 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
13095 have_address = want_address != 0;
13096 break;
13097 }
13098 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
13099 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
13100 {
13101 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
13102 return 0;
13103 }
13104 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
13105 {
13106 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
13107 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
13108 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
13109 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
13110 }
13111 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
13112 {
13113 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
13114 return 0;
13115 }
13116 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13117 {
13118 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13119 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13120 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13121 }
13122 else
13123 {
13124 enum machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
13125
13126 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
13127 if (want_address == 2)
13128 {
13129 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
13130 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13131 have_address = 1;
13132 }
13133 else
13134 {
13135 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13136 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
13137 if (MEM_P (rtl))
13138 {
13139 mem_mode = mode;
13140 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
13141 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
13142 have_address = 1;
13143 }
13144 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
13145 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13146 }
13147 if (!ret)
13148 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
13149 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
13150 }
13151 }
13152 break;
13153
13154 case MEM_REF:
13155 /* ??? FIXME. */
13156 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
13157 return 0;
13158 /* Fallthru. */
13159 case INDIRECT_REF:
13160 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
13161 have_address = 1;
13162 break;
13163
13164 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
13165 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
13166
13167 CASE_CONVERT:
13168 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
13169 case SAVE_EXPR:
13170 case MODIFY_EXPR:
13171 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
13172
13173 case COMPONENT_REF:
13174 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
13175 case ARRAY_REF:
13176 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
13177 case REALPART_EXPR:
13178 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
13179 {
13180 tree obj, offset;
13181 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
13182 enum machine_mode mode;
13183 int unsignedp, volatilep = 0;
13184
13185 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
13186 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
13187
13188 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
13189
13190 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
13191 want_address == 2
13192 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1);
13193 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
13194 for nonzero bitpos. */
13195 if (list_ret == 0)
13196 return 0;
13197 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
13198 {
13199 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13200 "bitfield access");
13201 return 0;
13202 }
13203
13204 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
13205 {
13206 /* Variable offset. */
13207 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
13208 if (list_ret1 == 0)
13209 return 0;
13210 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
13211 if (!list_ret)
13212 return 0;
13213 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13214 }
13215
13216 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
13217 if (bytepos > 0)
13218 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
13219 else if (bytepos < 0)
13220 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
13221
13222 have_address = 1;
13223 break;
13224 }
13225
13226 case INTEGER_CST:
13227 if ((want_address || !host_integerp (loc, 0))
13228 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
13229 have_address = 1;
13230 else if (want_address == 2
13231 && host_integerp (loc, 0)
13232 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
13233 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
13234 tree_low_cst (loc, 0))))
13235 have_address = 1;
13236 else if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
13237 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
13238 else
13239 {
13240 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13241 "Integer operand is not host integer");
13242 return 0;
13243 }
13244 break;
13245
13246 case CONSTRUCTOR:
13247 case REAL_CST:
13248 case STRING_CST:
13249 case COMPLEX_CST:
13250 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
13251 have_address = 1;
13252 else
13253 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
13254 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13255 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
13256 break;
13257
13258 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
13259 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
13260 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
13261 op = DW_OP_and;
13262 goto do_binop;
13263
13264 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
13265 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
13266 op = DW_OP_xor;
13267 goto do_binop;
13268
13269 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
13270 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
13271 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
13272 op = DW_OP_or;
13273 goto do_binop;
13274
13275 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
13276 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
13277 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
13278 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
13279 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
13280 return 0;
13281 op = DW_OP_div;
13282 goto do_binop;
13283
13284 case MINUS_EXPR:
13285 op = DW_OP_minus;
13286 goto do_binop;
13287
13288 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
13289 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
13290 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
13291 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
13292 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
13293 {
13294 op = DW_OP_mod;
13295 goto do_binop;
13296 }
13297 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
13298 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
13299 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
13300 return 0;
13301
13302 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
13303 if (list_ret == 0)
13304 return 0;
13305 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13306 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13307 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
13308 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13309 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13310 break;
13311
13312 case MULT_EXPR:
13313 op = DW_OP_mul;
13314 goto do_binop;
13315
13316 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
13317 op = DW_OP_shl;
13318 goto do_binop;
13319
13320 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
13321 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
13322 goto do_binop;
13323
13324 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
13325 case PLUS_EXPR:
13326 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
13327 {
13328 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
13329 if (list_ret == 0)
13330 return 0;
13331
13332 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0));
13333 break;
13334 }
13335
13336 op = DW_OP_plus;
13337 goto do_binop;
13338
13339 case LE_EXPR:
13340 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
13341 return 0;
13342
13343 op = DW_OP_le;
13344 goto do_binop;
13345
13346 case GE_EXPR:
13347 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
13348 return 0;
13349
13350 op = DW_OP_ge;
13351 goto do_binop;
13352
13353 case LT_EXPR:
13354 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
13355 return 0;
13356
13357 op = DW_OP_lt;
13358 goto do_binop;
13359
13360 case GT_EXPR:
13361 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
13362 return 0;
13363
13364 op = DW_OP_gt;
13365 goto do_binop;
13366
13367 case EQ_EXPR:
13368 op = DW_OP_eq;
13369 goto do_binop;
13370
13371 case NE_EXPR:
13372 op = DW_OP_ne;
13373 goto do_binop;
13374
13375 do_binop:
13376 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
13377 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
13378 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
13379 return 0;
13380
13381 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
13382 if (list_ret == 0)
13383 return 0;
13384 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13385 break;
13386
13387 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
13388 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
13389 op = DW_OP_not;
13390 goto do_unop;
13391
13392 case ABS_EXPR:
13393 op = DW_OP_abs;
13394 goto do_unop;
13395
13396 case NEGATE_EXPR:
13397 op = DW_OP_neg;
13398 goto do_unop;
13399
13400 do_unop:
13401 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
13402 if (list_ret == 0)
13403 return 0;
13404
13405 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13406 break;
13407
13408 case MIN_EXPR:
13409 case MAX_EXPR:
13410 {
13411 const enum tree_code code =
13412 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
13413
13414 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
13415 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
13416 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
13417 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
13418 }
13419
13420 /* ... fall through ... */
13421
13422 case COND_EXPR:
13423 {
13424 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
13425 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
13426 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
13427 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
13428 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
13429
13430 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
13431 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
13432 return 0;
13433
13434 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13435 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
13436
13437 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
13438 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13439 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
13440
13441 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
13442 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13443 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
13444
13445 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
13446 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
13447 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
13448 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13449 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
13450 }
13451 break;
13452
13453 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
13454 return 0;
13455
13456 default:
13457 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
13458 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
13459 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
13460 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
13461 {
13462 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13463 "language specific tree node");
13464 return 0;
13465 }
13466
13467 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13468 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
13469 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
13470 gcc_unreachable ();
13471 #else
13472 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
13473 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
13474 return NULL;
13475 #endif
13476 }
13477
13478 if (!ret && !list_ret)
13479 return 0;
13480
13481 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
13482 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13483 {
13484 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13485 {
13486 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13487 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13488 return 0;
13489 }
13490 if (ret)
13491 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13492 else
13493 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
13494 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13495 have_address = 1;
13496 }
13497 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
13498 if (want_address && !have_address)
13499 {
13500 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13501 "Want address and only have value");
13502 return 0;
13503 }
13504
13505 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
13506
13507 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
13508 if (!want_address && have_address)
13509 {
13510 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
13511
13512 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
13513 {
13514 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13515 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13516 return 0;
13517 }
13518 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13519 op = DW_OP_deref;
13520 else
13521 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
13522
13523 if (ret)
13524 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
13525 else
13526 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
13527 }
13528 if (ret)
13529 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
13530
13531 return list_ret;
13532 }
13533
13534 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
13535 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13536 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
13537 {
13538 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address);
13539 if (!ret)
13540 return NULL;
13541 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
13542 {
13543 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13544 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
13545 return NULL;
13546 }
13547 return ret->expr;
13548 }
13549
13550 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
13551 which is not less than the value itself. */
13552
13553 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
13554 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
13555 {
13556 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
13557 }
13558
13559 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
13560 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
13561 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
13562 ERROR_MARK node. */
13563
13564 static inline tree
13565 field_type (const_tree decl)
13566 {
13567 tree type;
13568
13569 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
13570 return integer_type_node;
13571
13572 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
13573 if (type == NULL_TREE)
13574 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
13575
13576 return type;
13577 }
13578
13579 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
13580 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
13581 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
13582
13583 static inline unsigned
13584 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
13585 {
13586 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
13587 }
13588
13589 static inline unsigned
13590 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
13591 {
13592 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
13593 }
13594
13595 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
13596
13597 static inline double_int
13598 round_up_to_align (double_int t, unsigned int align)
13599 {
13600 double_int alignd = uhwi_to_double_int (align);
13601 t = double_int_add (t, alignd);
13602 t = double_int_add (t, double_int_minus_one);
13603 t = double_int_div (t, alignd, true, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
13604 t = double_int_mul (t, alignd);
13605 return t;
13606 }
13607
13608 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
13609 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
13610 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
13611 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
13612 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
13613 just yet). */
13614
13615 static HOST_WIDE_INT
13616 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
13617 {
13618 double_int object_offset_in_bits;
13619 double_int object_offset_in_bytes;
13620 double_int bitpos_int;
13621
13622 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
13623 return 0;
13624
13625 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
13626
13627 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
13628 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
13629 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
13630 if (TREE_CODE (bit_position (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
13631 return 0;
13632
13633 bitpos_int = tree_to_double_int (bit_position (decl));
13634
13635 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
13636 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
13637 {
13638 tree type;
13639 tree field_size_tree;
13640 double_int deepest_bitpos;
13641 double_int field_size_in_bits;
13642 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
13643 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
13644 double_int type_size_in_bits;
13645
13646 type = field_type (decl);
13647 type_size_in_bits = double_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
13648 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
13649
13650 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
13651
13652 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
13653 a flexible array member. */
13654 if (!field_size_tree)
13655 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
13656
13657 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
13658 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
13659 field_size_in_bits = tree_to_double_int (field_size_tree);
13660 else
13661 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
13662
13663 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
13664
13665 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
13666 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
13667 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
13668 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
13669 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
13670 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
13671 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
13672 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
13673 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
13674
13675 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
13676
13677 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
13678 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
13679 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
13680 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
13681 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
13682 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
13683 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
13684 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
13685 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
13686 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
13687 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
13688
13689 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
13690 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
13691 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
13692 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
13693 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
13694 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
13695 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
13696 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
13697 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
13698 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
13699 structure type.)
13700
13701 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
13702 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
13703 must have believed that the containing object started (within
13704 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
13705 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
13706 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
13707 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
13708
13709 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
13710 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
13711 deepest_bitpos = double_int_add (bitpos_int, field_size_in_bits);
13712
13713 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
13714 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
13715 be. */
13716 object_offset_in_bits
13717 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
13718
13719 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
13720 bitfields. */
13721 object_offset_in_bits
13722 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
13723
13724 if (double_int_ucmp (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int) > 0)
13725 {
13726 object_offset_in_bits
13727 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
13728
13729 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
13730 object_offset_in_bits
13731 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
13732 }
13733 }
13734 else
13735 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
13736 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
13737
13738 object_offset_in_bytes
13739 = double_int_div (object_offset_in_bits,
13740 uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_UNIT), true,
13741 TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
13742 return double_int_to_shwi (object_offset_in_bytes);
13743 }
13744 \f
13745 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
13746 associated with them. */
13747
13748 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
13749
13750 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
13751 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
13752 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
13753
13754 static inline void
13755 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
13756 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
13757 {
13758 if (descr == 0)
13759 return;
13760 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
13761 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
13762 else
13763 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
13764 }
13765
13766 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
13767
13768 static void
13769 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
13770 {
13771 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
13772 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
13773 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
13774 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
13775 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
13776 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
13777 {
13778 if (dwarf_version == 2
13779 || die->die_parent == NULL
13780 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
13781 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
13782 }
13783 else if (dwarf_version > 2
13784 && die->die_parent
13785 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
13786 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
13787 }
13788
13789 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
13790 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
13791 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
13792 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
13793 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
13794 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
13795 function above).
13796
13797 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
13798 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
13799 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
13800 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
13801 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
13802 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
13803 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
13804 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
13805 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
13806 function below.) */
13807
13808 static void
13809 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
13810 {
13811 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
13812 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
13813
13814 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
13815 {
13816 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
13817 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
13818 {
13819 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
13820 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
13821 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
13822 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
13823
13824 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
13825
13826 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
13827
13828 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
13829
13830 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
13831 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
13832 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
13833
13834 /* Extract the vtable address. */
13835 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
13836 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
13837
13838 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
13839 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
13840 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
13841
13842 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
13843 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
13844 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
13845 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
13846
13847 /* Extract the offset. */
13848 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
13849 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
13850
13851 /* Add it to the object address. */
13852 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
13853 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
13854 }
13855 else
13856 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
13857 }
13858 else
13859 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
13860
13861 if (! loc_descr)
13862 {
13863 if (dwarf_version > 2)
13864 {
13865 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
13866 if (offset < 0)
13867 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
13868 else
13869 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
13870 return;
13871 }
13872 else
13873 {
13874 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13875
13876 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
13877 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
13878 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
13879 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
13880 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
13881 }
13882 }
13883
13884 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
13885 }
13886
13887 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
13888
13889 static void
13890 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
13891 {
13892 while (size != 0)
13893 {
13894 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
13895 val >>= 8;
13896 --size;
13897 }
13898 }
13899
13900 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
13901
13902 static HOST_WIDE_INT
13903 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
13904 {
13905 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
13906
13907 src += size;
13908 while (size != 0)
13909 {
13910 val <<= 8;
13911 val |= *--src & 0xff;
13912 --size;
13913 }
13914 return val;
13915 }
13916
13917 /* Writes double_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
13918
13919 static void
13920 insert_double (double_int val, unsigned char *dest)
13921 {
13922 unsigned char *p0 = dest;
13923 unsigned char *p1 = dest + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13924
13925 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13926 {
13927 p0 = p1;
13928 p1 = dest;
13929 }
13930
13931 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.low, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
13932 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.high, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
13933 }
13934
13935 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
13936
13937 static void
13938 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
13939 {
13940 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
13941 long val[4];
13942 int i;
13943
13944 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
13945 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
13946
13947 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
13948 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
13949 {
13950 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
13951 array += 4;
13952 }
13953 }
13954
13955 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
13956 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
13957 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
13958 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
13959 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
13960
13961 static bool
13962 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
13963 {
13964 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13965 {
13966 case CONST_INT:
13967 {
13968 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
13969
13970 if (val < 0)
13971 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
13972 else
13973 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
13974 }
13975 return true;
13976
13977 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13978 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
13979 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
13980 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
13981 represented. */
13982 {
13983 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13984
13985 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13986 {
13987 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13988 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
13989
13990 insert_float (rtl, array);
13991 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
13992 }
13993 else
13994 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
13995 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
13996 }
13997 return true;
13998
13999 case CONST_VECTOR:
14000 {
14001 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14002 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
14003 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
14004 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic
14005 (length * elt_size);
14006 unsigned int i;
14007 unsigned char *p;
14008
14009 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
14010 {
14011 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
14012 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14013 {
14014 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14015 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
14016
14017 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
14018 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
14019 else
14020 {
14021 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
14022 insert_double (val, p);
14023 }
14024 }
14025 break;
14026
14027 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
14028 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14029 {
14030 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14031 insert_float (elt, p);
14032 }
14033 break;
14034
14035 default:
14036 gcc_unreachable ();
14037 }
14038
14039 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
14040 }
14041 return true;
14042
14043 case CONST_STRING:
14044 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
14045 {
14046 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
14047 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
14048 rtl_addr:
14049 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
14050 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14051 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14052 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14053 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
14054 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
14055 return true;
14056 }
14057 return false;
14058
14059 case CONST:
14060 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14061 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
14062 /* FALLTHROUGH */
14063 case SYMBOL_REF:
14064 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14065 return false;
14066 case LABEL_REF:
14067 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
14068 goto rtl_addr;
14069 return false;
14070
14071 case PLUS:
14072 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
14073 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
14074 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
14075 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
14076 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
14077 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
14078 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
14079 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
14080 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
14081 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
14082 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
14083 return false;
14084
14085 case HIGH:
14086 case CONST_FIXED:
14087 return false;
14088
14089 case MEM:
14090 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
14091 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
14092 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
14093 {
14094 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
14095 return true;
14096 }
14097 return false;
14098
14099 default:
14100 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
14101 gcc_unreachable ();
14102 }
14103 return false;
14104 }
14105
14106 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
14107 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
14108 output). */
14109 static tree
14110 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
14111 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14112 {
14113 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
14114 *walk_subtrees = 0;
14115
14116 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
14117 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
14118 return *tp;
14119 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
14120 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
14121 be conservative. */
14122 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
14123 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
14124 return *tp;
14125 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
14126 {
14127 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (*tp);
14128 if (!node || !node->analyzed)
14129 return *tp;
14130 }
14131 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
14132 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
14133 {
14134 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
14135 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
14136 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
14137 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
14138 if (!cgraph_get_node (*tp))
14139 return *tp;
14140 }
14141 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
14142 return *tp;
14143
14144 return NULL_TREE;
14145 }
14146
14147 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
14148 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
14149
14150 static rtx
14151 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
14152 {
14153 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
14154
14155 STRIP_NOPS (init);
14156
14157 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
14158 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
14159 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
14160 {
14161 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
14162 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
14163 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
14164
14165 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
14166 && domain
14167 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
14168 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
14169 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
14170 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
14171 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
14172 {
14173 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
14174 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
14175 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
14176 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
14177 }
14178 }
14179 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
14180 CONCAT: FIXME! */
14181 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
14182 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
14183 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
14184 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
14185 ;
14186 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
14187 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
14188 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
14189 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
14190 ;
14191 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
14192 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
14193 reference variables which won't be output. */
14194 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
14195 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
14196 {
14197 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
14198 possible. */
14199 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
14200 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
14201 {
14202 case VECTOR_CST:
14203 break;
14204 case CONSTRUCTOR:
14205 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
14206 {
14207 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
14208 bool constant_p = true;
14209 tree value;
14210 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
14211
14212 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
14213 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
14214 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
14215 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
14216 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
14217 {
14218 constant_p = false;
14219 break;
14220 }
14221
14222 if (constant_p)
14223 {
14224 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
14225 break;
14226 }
14227 }
14228 /* FALLTHRU */
14229
14230 default:
14231 return NULL;
14232 }
14233
14234 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
14235
14236 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
14237 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
14238 }
14239
14240 return rtl;
14241 }
14242
14243 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
14244
14245 static rtx
14246 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
14247 {
14248 rtx rtl;
14249
14250 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
14251 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
14252 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
14253
14254 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
14255 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
14256 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
14257 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
14258 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
14259 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
14260 referenced within the function.
14261
14262 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
14263 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
14264 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
14265 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
14266
14267 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
14268 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
14269 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
14270 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
14271 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
14272 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
14273
14274 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
14275 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
14276 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
14277 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
14278 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
14279 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
14280 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
14281 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
14282 output at debug-time.
14283
14284 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
14285 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
14286 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
14287 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
14288 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
14289 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
14290 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
14291 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
14292 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
14293 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
14294 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
14295 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
14296 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
14297
14298 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
14299 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
14300 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
14301 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
14302 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
14303 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
14304 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
14305 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
14306 I'd like to fix it.
14307
14308 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
14309 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
14310 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
14311 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
14312 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
14313 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
14314 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
14315 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
14316 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
14317 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
14318 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
14319
14320 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
14321 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
14322
14323 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
14324 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
14325 fixed registers. */
14326 if (! reload_completed)
14327 {
14328 if (rtl
14329 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
14330 || (MEM_P (rtl)
14331 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14332 || (REG_P (rtl)
14333 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
14334 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
14335 {
14336 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
14337 return rtl;
14338 }
14339 rtl = NULL_RTX;
14340 }
14341 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
14342 {
14343 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
14344 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
14345 || (MEM_P (rtl)
14346 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14347 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
14348 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
14349 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
14350 {
14351 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
14352 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
14353 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
14354 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
14355
14356 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
14357 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
14358 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
14359 if (dmode == pmode)
14360 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
14361 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
14362 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
14363 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
14364 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
14365 {
14366 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
14367 if (REG_P (inc))
14368 rtl = inc;
14369 else if (MEM_P (inc))
14370 {
14371 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
14372 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
14373 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
14374 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
14375 else
14376 rtl = inc;
14377 }
14378 }
14379 }
14380
14381 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
14382 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
14383 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
14384 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
14385 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
14386 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
14387 thing to do. */
14388 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
14389 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
14390 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14391 /* Not passed in memory. */
14392 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
14393 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
14394 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14395 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
14396 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
14397 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
14398 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
14399 #endif
14400 )
14401 /* Big endian correction check. */
14402 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
14403 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
14404 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
14405 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
14406 {
14407 enum machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
14408 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
14409 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
14410
14411 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
14412 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
14413 }
14414 }
14415 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
14416 && rtl
14417 && MEM_P (rtl)
14418 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
14419 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
14420 {
14421 enum machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
14422 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
14423 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
14424
14425 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
14426 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
14427 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
14428 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
14429 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
14430 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
14431 if (rsize > dsize)
14432 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
14433 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
14434 rsize - dsize));
14435 }
14436
14437 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
14438 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
14439 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
14440 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
14441 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
14442
14443 if (rtl)
14444 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
14445
14446 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
14447 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
14448 code, and thus is not emitted. */
14449 if (rtl)
14450 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14451
14452 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
14453 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
14454 it. */
14455 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
14456 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
14457 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
14458 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
14459 && DECL_NAME (decl)
14460 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
14461 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
14462 {
14463 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
14464 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
14465 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
14466 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
14467 rtl = NULL_RTX;
14468 }
14469
14470 return rtl;
14471 }
14472
14473 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
14474 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
14475 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
14476
14477 static tree
14478 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
14479 {
14480 tree val_expr, cvar;
14481 enum machine_mode mode;
14482 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
14483 tree offset;
14484 int unsignedp, volatilep = 0;
14485
14486 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
14487 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
14488 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
14489 be handled as such. */
14490 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
14491 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
14492 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
14493 || !is_fortran ())
14494 return NULL_TREE;
14495
14496 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
14497 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
14498 return NULL_TREE;
14499
14500 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
14501 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
14502
14503 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
14504 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
14505 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
14506 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
14507 return NULL_TREE;
14508
14509 *value = 0;
14510 if (offset != NULL)
14511 {
14512 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
14513 return NULL_TREE;
14514 *value = tree_low_cst (offset, 0);
14515 }
14516 if (bitpos != 0)
14517 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14518
14519 return cvar;
14520 }
14521
14522 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
14523 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
14524 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
14525 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
14526 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
14527 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
14528 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
14529 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
14530 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
14531 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
14532
14533 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
14534 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
14535 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
14536 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
14537
14538 static bool
14539 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p,
14540 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
14541 {
14542 rtx rtl;
14543 dw_loc_list_ref list;
14544 var_loc_list *loc_list;
14545 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
14546 void **slot;
14547
14548 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
14549 return false;
14550
14551 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
14552 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
14553
14554 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
14555 the location. */
14556
14557 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
14558 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
14559 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
14560 return true;
14561
14562 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
14563 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
14564 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
14565 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
14566 if (loc_list
14567 && loc_list->first
14568 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
14569 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
14570 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
14571 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
14572 {
14573 struct var_loc_node *node;
14574
14575 node = loc_list->first;
14576 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
14577 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
14578 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14579 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
14580 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
14581 return true;
14582 }
14583 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
14584 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
14585 list = NULL;
14586 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
14587 cache_p = false;
14588 if (cache_p)
14589 {
14590 cache = (cached_dw_loc_list *)
14591 htab_find_with_hash (cached_dw_loc_list_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
14592 if (cache)
14593 list = cache->loc_list;
14594 }
14595 if (list == NULL)
14596 {
14597 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2);
14598 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
14599 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
14600 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
14601 {
14602 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (cached_dw_loc_list_table, decl,
14603 DECL_UID (decl), INSERT);
14604 cache = ggc_alloc_cleared_cached_dw_loc_list ();
14605 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
14606 cache->loc_list = list;
14607 *slot = cache;
14608 }
14609 }
14610 if (list)
14611 {
14612 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
14613 return true;
14614 }
14615 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
14616 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
14617 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
14618 }
14619
14620 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
14621
14622 static void
14623 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
14624 {
14625 deferred_locations entry;
14626 entry.variable = variable;
14627 entry.die = die;
14628 VEC_safe_push (deferred_locations, gc, deferred_locations_list, &entry);
14629 }
14630
14631 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
14632 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
14633
14634 static bool
14635 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
14636 {
14637 tree type;
14638
14639 if (init == NULL_TREE)
14640 return false;
14641
14642 STRIP_NOPS (init);
14643 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
14644 {
14645 case STRING_CST:
14646 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
14647 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
14648 {
14649 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
14650 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
14651
14652 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
14653 return false;
14654 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
14655 return false;
14656 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
14657 {
14658 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
14659 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
14660 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
14661 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
14662 }
14663 else
14664 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
14665 return true;
14666 }
14667 return false;
14668 case CONSTRUCTOR:
14669 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
14670 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
14671 return false;
14672 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
14673 {
14674 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
14675 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
14676 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
14677 constructor_elt *ce;
14678
14679 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
14680 || !host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0))
14681 return false;
14682
14683 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
14684 if (fieldsize <= 0)
14685 return false;
14686
14687 min_index = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0);
14688 memset (array, '\0', size);
14689 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
14690 {
14691 tree val = ce->value;
14692 tree index = ce->index;
14693 int pos = curpos;
14694 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
14695 pos = (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0) - min_index)
14696 * fieldsize;
14697 else if (index)
14698 pos = (tree_low_cst (index, 0) - min_index) * fieldsize;
14699
14700 if (val)
14701 {
14702 STRIP_NOPS (val);
14703 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
14704 return false;
14705 }
14706 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
14707 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
14708 {
14709 int count = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1), 0)
14710 - tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0);
14711 while (count-- > 0)
14712 {
14713 if (val)
14714 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
14715 curpos += fieldsize;
14716 }
14717 }
14718 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
14719 }
14720 return true;
14721 }
14722 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
14723 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
14724 {
14725 tree field = NULL_TREE;
14726 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
14727 constructor_elt *ce;
14728
14729 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
14730 return false;
14731
14732 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
14733 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
14734
14735 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
14736 {
14737 tree val = ce->value;
14738 int pos, fieldsize;
14739
14740 if (ce->index != 0)
14741 field = ce->index;
14742
14743 if (val)
14744 STRIP_NOPS (val);
14745
14746 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
14747 return false;
14748
14749 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
14750 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
14751 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
14752 return false;
14753 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
14754 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0))
14755 return false;
14756 fieldsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0);
14757 pos = int_byte_position (field);
14758 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
14759 if (val
14760 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
14761 return false;
14762 }
14763 return true;
14764 }
14765 return false;
14766 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
14767 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
14768 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
14769 default:
14770 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
14771 }
14772 }
14773
14774 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
14775 attribute is the const value T. */
14776
14777 static bool
14778 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
14779 {
14780 tree init;
14781 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
14782 rtx rtl;
14783
14784 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
14785 return false;
14786
14787 init = t;
14788 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
14789
14790 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
14791 if (rtl)
14792 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
14793 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
14794 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
14795 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
14796 {
14797 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
14798 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
14799 {
14800 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
14801 ggc_alloc_cleared_atomic (size);
14802
14803 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
14804 {
14805 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
14806 return true;
14807 }
14808 }
14809 }
14810 return false;
14811 }
14812
14813 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
14814 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
14815 variable with static storage duration
14816 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
14817
14818 static bool
14819 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
14820 {
14821
14822 if (!decl
14823 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
14824 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
14825 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
14826 && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
14827 return false;
14828
14829 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
14830 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
14831 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
14832 /* OK */;
14833 else
14834 return false;
14835
14836 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
14837 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
14838 return false;
14839
14840 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
14841 }
14842
14843 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
14844 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
14845 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
14846 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
14847 expressions. */
14848
14849 static dw_loc_list_ref
14850 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14851 {
14852 int ix;
14853 dw_fde_ref fde;
14854 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
14855 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
14856 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
14857 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
14858 dw_cfa_location remember;
14859
14860 fde = cfun->fde;
14861 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
14862
14863 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
14864 list_tail = &list;
14865 list = NULL;
14866
14867 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
14868 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
14869 remember = next_cfa;
14870
14871 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
14872
14873 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
14874 advance opcodes. */
14875 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
14876 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
14877
14878 last_cfa = next_cfa;
14879 last_label = start_label;
14880
14881 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
14882 {
14883 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
14884 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
14885 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
14886 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
14887 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14888 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
14889 }
14890
14891 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
14892 {
14893 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
14894 {
14895 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
14896 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
14897 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
14898 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
14899 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
14900 {
14901 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
14902 start_label, last_label, section);
14903
14904 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14905 last_cfa = next_cfa;
14906 start_label = last_label;
14907 }
14908 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
14909 break;
14910
14911 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
14912 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
14913 gcc_unreachable ();
14914
14915 default:
14916 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
14917 break;
14918 }
14919 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
14920 {
14921 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
14922 {
14923 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
14924 start_label, last_label, section);
14925
14926 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14927 last_cfa = next_cfa;
14928 start_label = last_label;
14929 }
14930 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
14931 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
14932 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14933 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
14934 }
14935 }
14936
14937 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
14938 {
14939 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
14940 start_label, last_label, section);
14941 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14942 start_label = last_label;
14943 }
14944
14945 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
14946 start_label,
14947 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
14948 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
14949 section);
14950
14951 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
14952 gen_llsym (list);
14953
14954 return list;
14955 }
14956
14957 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
14958 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
14959 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
14960 before the latter is negated. */
14961
14962 static void
14963 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14964 {
14965 rtx reg, elim;
14966
14967 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
14968 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
14969 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
14970 #else
14971 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
14972 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
14973 #endif
14974
14975 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
14976 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
14977 {
14978 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
14979 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
14980 }
14981
14982 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
14983
14984 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
14985 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
14986 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
14987 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
14988 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
14989 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
14990 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
14991 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
14992 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
14993 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
14994 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
14995 : stack_pointer_rtx));
14996 }
14997
14998 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
14999 the value of the attribute. */
15000
15001 static void
15002 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
15003 {
15004 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
15005 {
15006 if (demangle_name_func)
15007 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
15008
15009 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
15010 }
15011 }
15012
15013 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
15014 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
15015 of TYPE accordingly.
15016
15017 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
15018 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
15019
15020 static void
15021 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
15022 dw_die_ref context_die)
15023 {
15024 tree dtype;
15025 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
15026
15027 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
15028 return;
15029
15030 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
15031 if (!dtype)
15032 return;
15033
15034 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
15035 if (!dtype_die)
15036 {
15037 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
15038 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
15039 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
15040 }
15041
15042 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
15043 }
15044
15045 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
15046
15047 static void
15048 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
15049 {
15050 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
15051 char *wd1;
15052
15053 if (wd == NULL)
15054 return;
15055
15056 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
15057 {
15058 int wdlen;
15059
15060 wdlen = strlen (wd);
15061 wd1 = (char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (wdlen + 2);
15062 strcpy (wd1, wd);
15063 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
15064 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
15065 wd = wd1;
15066 }
15067
15068 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
15069 }
15070
15071 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
15072 default. */
15073
15074 static int
15075 lower_bound_default (void)
15076 {
15077 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
15078 {
15079 case DW_LANG_C:
15080 case DW_LANG_C89:
15081 case DW_LANG_C99:
15082 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
15083 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
15084 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
15085 case DW_LANG_Java:
15086 return 0;
15087 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
15088 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
15089 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
15090 return 1;
15091 case DW_LANG_UPC:
15092 case DW_LANG_D:
15093 case DW_LANG_Python:
15094 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
15095 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
15096 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
15097 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
15098 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
15099 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
15100 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
15101 case DW_LANG_PLI:
15102 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
15103 default:
15104 return -1;
15105 }
15106 }
15107
15108 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
15109 a representation for that bound. */
15110
15111 static void
15112 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
15113 {
15114 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
15115 {
15116 case ERROR_MARK:
15117 return;
15118
15119 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
15120 case INTEGER_CST:
15121 {
15122 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (bound));
15123 int dflt;
15124
15125 /* Use the default if possible. */
15126 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
15127 && host_integerp (bound, 0)
15128 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
15129 && tree_low_cst (bound, 0) == dflt)
15130 ;
15131
15132 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with the
15133 precision of its type. The precision and signedness of the
15134 type will be necessary to re-interpret it unambiguously. */
15135 else if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15136 {
15137 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
15138 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1;
15139 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
15140 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound) & mask);
15141 }
15142 else if (prec == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15143 || TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound) == 0)
15144 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
15145 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
15146 else
15147 add_AT_double (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound),
15148 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
15149 }
15150 break;
15151
15152 CASE_CONVERT:
15153 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
15154 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
15155 break;
15156
15157 case SAVE_EXPR:
15158 break;
15159
15160 case VAR_DECL:
15161 case PARM_DECL:
15162 case RESULT_DECL:
15163 {
15164 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
15165
15166 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
15167 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
15168 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
15169 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
15170 later parameter. */
15171 if (decl_die != NULL)
15172 {
15173 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
15174 break;
15175 }
15176 }
15177 /* FALLTHRU */
15178
15179 default:
15180 {
15181 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
15182 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
15183
15184 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
15185 dw_loc_list_ref list;
15186
15187 list = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 2);
15188 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
15189 {
15190 /* If DW_AT_*bound is not a reference nor constant, it is
15191 a DWARF expression rather than location description.
15192 For that loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0) is needed.
15193 If that fails to give a single element list,
15194 fall back to outputting this as a reference anyway. */
15195 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0);
15196 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
15197 {
15198 add_AT_loc (subrange_die, bound_attr, list2->expr);
15199 break;
15200 }
15201 }
15202 if (list == NULL)
15203 break;
15204
15205 if (current_function_decl == 0)
15206 ctx = comp_unit_die ();
15207 else
15208 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
15209
15210 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
15211 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
15212 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
15213 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
15214 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
15215 break;
15216 }
15217 }
15218 }
15219
15220 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
15221 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
15222 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
15223 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
15224
15225 static void
15226 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
15227 {
15228 unsigned dimension_number;
15229 tree lower, upper;
15230 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
15231
15232 for (dimension_number = 0;
15233 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
15234 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
15235 {
15236 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
15237
15238 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
15239 break;
15240
15241 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
15242 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
15243 here. */
15244 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
15245 if (domain)
15246 {
15247 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
15248 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
15249 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
15250
15251 /* Define the index type. */
15252 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
15253 {
15254 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
15255 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
15256 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
15257 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
15258 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
15259 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
15260 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
15261 ;
15262 else
15263 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
15264 type_die);
15265 }
15266
15267 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
15268 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
15269 dimension arr(N:*)
15270 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
15271 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
15272 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
15273
15274 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
15275 if (upper)
15276 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
15277 }
15278
15279 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
15280 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
15281 bounds. */
15282 }
15283 }
15284
15285 static void
15286 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
15287 {
15288 dw_die_ref decl_die;
15289 unsigned size;
15290
15291 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
15292 {
15293 case ERROR_MARK:
15294 size = 0;
15295 break;
15296 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
15297 case RECORD_TYPE:
15298 case UNION_TYPE:
15299 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
15300 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
15301 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
15302 {
15303 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
15304 return;
15305 }
15306 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
15307 break;
15308 case FIELD_DECL:
15309 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
15310 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
15311 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
15312 even for bit-fields. */
15313 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15314 break;
15315 default:
15316 gcc_unreachable ();
15317 }
15318
15319 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
15320 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
15321 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
15322 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
15323 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
15324 }
15325
15326 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
15327 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
15328 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
15329 bit-field itself.
15330
15331 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
15332 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
15333 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
15334 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
15335 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
15336 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
15337
15338 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
15339 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
15340 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
15341
15342 static inline void
15343 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15344 {
15345 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
15346 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
15347 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
15348 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
15349 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
15350 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
15351
15352 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
15353 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
15354
15355 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
15356 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
15357 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
15358 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
15359 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
15360 return;
15361
15362 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
15363
15364 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
15365 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
15366 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
15367 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
15368 below must take account of these differences. */
15369 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
15370 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
15371
15372 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15373 {
15374 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
15375 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
15376 }
15377
15378 bit_offset
15379 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
15380 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
15381 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
15382
15383 if (bit_offset < 0)
15384 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
15385 else
15386 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
15387 }
15388
15389 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
15390 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
15391
15392 static inline void
15393 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15394 {
15395 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
15396 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
15397 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
15398
15399 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
15400 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
15401 }
15402
15403 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
15404 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
15405
15406 static inline void
15407 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
15408 {
15409 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
15410 && prototype_p (func_type))
15411 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
15412 }
15413
15414 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
15415 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
15416 equate table. */
15417
15418 static inline dw_die_ref
15419 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
15420 {
15421 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
15422
15423 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
15424 {
15425 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
15426 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
15427 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
15428
15429 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
15430 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
15431 tree fn = origin;
15432
15433 if (TYPE_P (fn))
15434 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
15435
15436 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
15437 if (fn)
15438 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
15439 }
15440
15441 if (DECL_P (origin))
15442 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
15443 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
15444 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
15445
15446 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
15447 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
15448 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
15449 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
15450 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
15451 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
15452 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
15453 here. */
15454
15455 if (origin_die)
15456 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
15457 return origin_die;
15458 }
15459
15460 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
15461
15462 static inline void
15463 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
15464 {
15465 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
15466 {
15467 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
15468
15469 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
15470 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
15471 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
15472 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
15473 0));
15474
15475 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
15476 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
15477 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
15478 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
15479 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
15480 }
15481 }
15482 \f
15483 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
15484 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
15485 standardized it. */
15486
15487 static void
15488 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15489 {
15490 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
15491
15492 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
15493 if (name[0] == '*')
15494 name = &name[1];
15495
15496 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
15497 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
15498 else
15499 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
15500 }
15501
15502 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
15503
15504 static void
15505 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15506 {
15507 expanded_location s;
15508
15509 if (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
15510 return;
15511 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
15512 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
15513 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
15514 }
15515
15516 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
15517
15518 static void
15519 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15520 {
15521 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
15522 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
15523 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
15524 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
15525 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
15526 {
15527 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
15528 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
15529 {
15530 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
15531
15532 asm_name = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
15533 asm_name->die = die;
15534 asm_name->created_for = decl;
15535 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
15536 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
15537 }
15538 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
15539 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
15540 }
15541 }
15542
15543 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
15544 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
15545
15546 static void
15547 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15548 {
15549 tree decl_name;
15550
15551 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
15552 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
15553 {
15554 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
15555 if (name)
15556 add_name_attribute (die, name);
15557 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
15558 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
15559
15560 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
15561 }
15562
15563 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
15564 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
15565 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
15566 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
15567 {
15568 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
15569 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
15570 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
15571 }
15572 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
15573 }
15574
15575 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
15576 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
15577
15578 void
15579 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
15580 {
15581 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
15582 dw_die_ref die;
15583
15584 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
15585 die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
15586 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
15587 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
15588 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
15589 current_function_funcdef_no);
15590 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
15591
15592 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
15593 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
15594 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
15595 {
15596 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
15597 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
15598 }
15599 else
15600 {
15601 die->die_sib = die;
15602 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
15603 }
15604 }
15605 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
15606
15607 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
15608
15609 static void
15610 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
15611 {
15612 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
15613 }
15614
15615 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
15616
15617 static inline void
15618 pop_decl_scope (void)
15619 {
15620 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
15621 }
15622
15623 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
15624
15625 static tree
15626 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15627 {
15628 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
15629 *walk_subtrees = 0;
15630 else
15631 {
15632 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
15633 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
15634 return *tp;
15635 }
15636 return NULL_TREE;
15637 }
15638
15639 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
15640 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
15641
15642 static tree
15643 uses_local_type (tree type)
15644 {
15645 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
15646 return used;
15647 }
15648
15649 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
15650 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
15651 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
15652 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
15653 the current active scope. */
15654
15655 static dw_die_ref
15656 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
15657 {
15658 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
15659 tree containing_scope;
15660
15661 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
15662 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
15663
15664 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
15665 it refers to. */
15666 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
15667 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
15668 else
15669 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
15670
15671 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
15672 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
15673 {
15674 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
15675 /* OK */;
15676 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
15677 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
15678 else
15679 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
15680 }
15681
15682 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
15683 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
15684 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
15685 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
15686 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
15687
15688 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
15689 {
15690 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
15691 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
15692 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
15693 scope_die = context_die;
15694 else
15695 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
15696 }
15697 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
15698 {
15699 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
15700 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
15701 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
15702 else
15703 {
15704 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
15705 if (scope_die == NULL)
15706 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
15707 }
15708 }
15709 else
15710 scope_die = context_die;
15711
15712 return scope_die;
15713 }
15714
15715 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
15716
15717 static inline int
15718 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
15719 {
15720 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
15721 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
15722 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
15723 return 1;
15724
15725 return 0;
15726 }
15727
15728 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
15729
15730 static inline int
15731 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
15732 {
15733 return (context_die
15734 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
15735 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
15736 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
15737 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
15738 }
15739
15740 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
15741 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
15742
15743 static inline int
15744 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
15745 {
15746 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
15747 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
15748 }
15749
15750 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
15751 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
15752 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
15753
15754 static void
15755 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
15756 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
15757 {
15758 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
15759 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
15760
15761 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
15762 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
15763 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
15764 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
15765 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
15766 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
15767 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
15768
15769 if (code == ERROR_MARK
15770 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
15771 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
15772 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
15773 || code == VOID_TYPE)
15774 return;
15775
15776 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
15777 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
15778 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
15779 context_die);
15780
15781 if (type_die != NULL)
15782 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
15783 }
15784
15785 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
15786 function call type. */
15787 static void
15788 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
15789 {
15790 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
15791
15792 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
15793 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
15794
15795 if (is_fortran ()
15796 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
15797 {
15798 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
15799 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
15800 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
15801 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
15802 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
15803 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
15804 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
15805 value = DW_CC_program;
15806
15807 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
15808 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
15809 }
15810
15811 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
15812 is not DW_CC_normal. */
15813 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
15814 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
15815 }
15816
15817 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
15818 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
15819 was declared without a tag. */
15820
15821 static const char *
15822 type_tag (const_tree type)
15823 {
15824 const char *name = 0;
15825
15826 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
15827 {
15828 tree t = 0;
15829
15830 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
15831 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
15832 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
15833 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
15834
15835 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
15836 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
15837 involved. */
15838 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
15839 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
15840 {
15841 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
15842 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
15843 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
15844 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
15845 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
15846 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
15847 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
15848 }
15849
15850 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
15851 if (!name && t != 0)
15852 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
15853 }
15854
15855 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
15856 }
15857
15858 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
15859 for bit field types. */
15860
15861 static inline tree
15862 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
15863 {
15864 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
15865 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
15866 }
15867
15868 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
15869 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
15870
15871 #if 0
15872 static const char *
15873 decl_start_label (tree decl)
15874 {
15875 rtx x;
15876 const char *fnname;
15877
15878 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
15879 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
15880
15881 x = XEXP (x, 0);
15882 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
15883
15884 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
15885 return fnname;
15886 }
15887 #endif
15888 \f
15889 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
15890 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
15891 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
15892
15893 static void
15894 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
15895 {
15896 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
15897 dw_die_ref array_die;
15898
15899 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
15900 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
15901 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
15902 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
15903 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
15904 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
15905 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
15906 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
15907 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
15908
15909 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
15910 tree element_type;
15911
15912 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
15913 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
15914 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
15915 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
15916 && is_fortran ()
15917 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
15918 {
15919 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
15920
15921 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
15922 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
15923 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
15924 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
15925 if (size >= 0)
15926 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
15927 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
15928 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
15929 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
15930 {
15931 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
15932 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2);
15933
15934 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
15935 if (loc && size > 0)
15936 {
15937 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
15938 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15939 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
15940 }
15941 }
15942 return;
15943 }
15944
15945 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
15946 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
15947 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
15948
15949 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
15950 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
15951
15952 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
15953 if (is_fortran ()
15954 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
15955 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
15956 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
15957 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
15958
15959 #if 0
15960 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
15961 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
15962 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
15963 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
15964 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
15965 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
15966 for multidimensional arrays. */
15967 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
15968 #endif
15969
15970 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
15971 {
15972 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
15973 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
15974 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node);
15975 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
15976 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1));
15977 }
15978 else
15979 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
15980
15981 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
15982 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
15983 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
15984 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
15985 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15986 {
15987 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
15988 break;
15989 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
15990 }
15991
15992 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
15993
15994 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
15995 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
15996 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
15997
15998 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
15999 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
16000 }
16001
16002 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16003 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
16004 {
16005 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
16006 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
16007 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16008
16009 if (val == base_decl)
16010 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
16011
16012 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
16013 {
16014 CASE_CONVERT:
16015 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16016 case VAR_DECL:
16017 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, 0);
16018 case INTEGER_CST:
16019 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
16020 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
16021 break;
16022 case INDIRECT_REF:
16023 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
16024 if (size < 0)
16025 break;
16026 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16027 if (!loc)
16028 break;
16029 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16030 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
16031 else
16032 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
16033 return loc;
16034 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
16035 case PLUS_EXPR:
16036 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
16037 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
16038 < 16384)
16039 {
16040 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16041 if (!loc)
16042 break;
16043 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 0));
16044 }
16045 else
16046 {
16047 op = DW_OP_plus;
16048 do_binop:
16049 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16050 if (!loc)
16051 break;
16052 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
16053 if (!loc2)
16054 break;
16055 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
16056 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16057 }
16058 return loc;
16059 case MINUS_EXPR:
16060 op = DW_OP_minus;
16061 goto do_binop;
16062 case MULT_EXPR:
16063 op = DW_OP_mul;
16064 goto do_binop;
16065 case EQ_EXPR:
16066 op = DW_OP_eq;
16067 goto do_binop;
16068 case NE_EXPR:
16069 op = DW_OP_ne;
16070 goto do_binop;
16071 default:
16072 break;
16073 }
16074 return NULL;
16075 }
16076
16077 static void
16078 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
16079 tree val, tree base_decl)
16080 {
16081 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
16082
16083 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
16084 {
16085 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
16086 return;
16087 }
16088
16089 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
16090 if (!loc)
16091 return;
16092
16093 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
16094 }
16095
16096 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
16097 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
16098
16099 static void
16100 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
16101 dw_die_ref context_die)
16102 {
16103 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
16104 dw_die_ref array_die;
16105 int dim;
16106
16107 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
16108 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
16109 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
16110
16111 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
16112 if (is_fortran ()
16113 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
16114 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
16115
16116 if (info->data_location)
16117 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
16118 info->base_decl);
16119 if (info->associated)
16120 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
16121 info->base_decl);
16122 if (info->allocated)
16123 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
16124 info->base_decl);
16125
16126 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
16127 {
16128 dw_die_ref subrange_die
16129 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
16130
16131 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
16132 {
16133 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
16134 int dflt;
16135
16136 if (host_integerp (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0)
16137 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
16138 && tree_low_cst (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0) == dflt)
16139 ;
16140 else
16141 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
16142 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
16143 info->base_decl);
16144 }
16145 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
16146 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
16147 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
16148 info->base_decl);
16149 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
16150 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
16151 info->dimen[dim].stride,
16152 info->base_decl);
16153 }
16154
16155 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
16156 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
16157
16158 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
16159 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
16160 }
16161
16162 #if 0
16163 static void
16164 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
16165 {
16166 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
16167 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
16168
16169 if (origin != NULL)
16170 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
16171 else
16172 {
16173 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
16174 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
16175 0, 0, context_die);
16176 }
16177
16178 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
16179 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
16180 else
16181 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
16182 }
16183 #endif
16184
16185 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
16186 emit full debugging info for them. */
16187
16188 static void
16189 retry_incomplete_types (void)
16190 {
16191 int i;
16192
16193 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
16194 if (should_emit_struct_debug (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i),
16195 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
16196 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die ());
16197 }
16198
16199 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
16200
16201 static enum dwarf_tag
16202 record_type_tag (tree type)
16203 {
16204 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
16205 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
16206
16207 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
16208 {
16209 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
16210 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
16211
16212 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
16213 return DW_TAG_class_type;
16214
16215 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
16216 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
16217 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
16218 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
16219
16220 default:
16221 gcc_unreachable ();
16222 }
16223 }
16224
16225 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
16226 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
16227 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
16228 DIE. */
16229
16230 static dw_die_ref
16231 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
16232 {
16233 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
16234
16235 if (type_die == NULL)
16236 {
16237 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
16238 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
16239 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
16240 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
16241 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16242 {
16243 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
16244 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
16245 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
16246 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
16247 }
16248 }
16249 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
16250 return type_die;
16251 else
16252 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
16253
16254 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
16255 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
16256 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
16257 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
16258 {
16259 tree link;
16260
16261 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
16262 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
16263 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
16264 {
16265 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
16266 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
16267 }
16268
16269 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
16270 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
16271 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
16272 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
16273
16274 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
16275 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
16276 {
16277 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
16278 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
16279
16280 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
16281 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
16282
16283 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
16284 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
16285
16286 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
16287 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
16288 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
16289 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
16290 values as if they were signed. That means that
16291 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
16292 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
16293 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
16294 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
16295 }
16296
16297 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
16298 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
16299 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16300 }
16301 else
16302 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
16303
16304 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
16305
16306 return type_die;
16307 }
16308
16309 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
16310 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
16311 type.
16312
16313 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
16314 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
16315 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
16316 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
16317 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
16318 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
16319 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
16320 argument type of some subprogram type.
16321 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
16322 are emitted. */
16323
16324 static dw_die_ref
16325 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
16326 dw_die_ref context_die)
16327 {
16328 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
16329 tree ultimate_origin;
16330 dw_die_ref parm_die
16331 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
16332
16333 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
16334 {
16335 case tcc_declaration:
16336 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
16337 if (node || ultimate_origin)
16338 origin = ultimate_origin;
16339 if (origin != NULL)
16340 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
16341 else if (emit_name_p)
16342 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
16343 if (origin == NULL
16344 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin)
16345 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
16346 decl_function_context
16347 (node_or_origin))))
16348 {
16349 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
16350 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
16351 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0,
16352 context_die);
16353 else
16354 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
16355 TREE_READONLY (node_or_origin),
16356 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node_or_origin),
16357 context_die);
16358 }
16359 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
16360 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16361
16362 if (node && node != origin)
16363 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
16364 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin))
16365 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
16366 node == NULL, DW_AT_location);
16367
16368 break;
16369
16370 case tcc_type:
16371 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
16372 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, 0, 0, context_die);
16373 break;
16374
16375 default:
16376 gcc_unreachable ();
16377 }
16378
16379 return parm_die;
16380 }
16381
16382 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
16383 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
16384 parameter pack.
16385
16386 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
16387 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
16388 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
16389 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
16390 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
16391 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
16392
16393 static dw_die_ref
16394 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
16395 tree pack_arg,
16396 dw_die_ref subr_die,
16397 tree *next_arg)
16398 {
16399 tree arg;
16400 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
16401
16402 gcc_assert (parm_pack
16403 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
16404 && subr_die);
16405
16406 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
16407 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
16408
16409 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
16410 {
16411 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
16412 parm_pack))
16413 break;
16414 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
16415 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
16416 parm_pack_die);
16417 }
16418 if (next_arg)
16419 *next_arg = arg;
16420 return parm_pack_die;
16421 }
16422
16423 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
16424 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
16425
16426 static void
16427 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
16428 {
16429 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
16430 }
16431
16432 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
16433 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
16434 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
16435 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
16436
16437 static void
16438 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
16439 {
16440 tree link;
16441 tree formal_type = NULL;
16442 tree first_parm_type;
16443 tree arg;
16444
16445 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
16446 {
16447 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
16448 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
16449 }
16450 else
16451 arg = NULL_TREE;
16452
16453 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
16454
16455 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
16456 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
16457 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
16458 {
16459 dw_die_ref parm_die;
16460
16461 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
16462 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
16463 break;
16464
16465 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
16466 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
16467 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
16468 context_die);
16469 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
16470 && link == first_parm_type)
16471 {
16472 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16473 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
16474 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
16475 }
16476 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
16477 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16478
16479 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
16480 if (arg)
16481 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
16482 }
16483
16484 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
16485 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
16486 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
16487 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
16488
16489 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
16490 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
16491 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
16492 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
16493 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
16494 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
16495 }
16496
16497 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
16498 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
16499 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
16500 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
16501 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
16502
16503 static void
16504 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
16505 {
16506 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
16507
16508 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
16509 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
16510 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
16511 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
16512 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
16513 {
16514 dw_die_ref type_die;
16515 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
16516
16517 push_decl_scope (type);
16518 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
16519 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
16520 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
16521 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
16522 {
16523 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
16524 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
16525 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
16526 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
16527 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
16528 {
16529 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
16530 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
16531 }
16532 }
16533 else
16534 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
16535
16536 pop_decl_scope ();
16537 }
16538 }
16539 \f
16540 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
16541 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
16542 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
16543 static void set_decl_abstract_flags (tree, int);
16544
16545 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
16546 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
16547 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
16548 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
16549 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
16550 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
16551 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
16552 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
16553 values to point to themselves. */
16554
16555 static void
16556 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
16557 {
16558 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
16559 {
16560 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
16561
16562 {
16563 tree local_decl;
16564
16565 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
16566 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
16567 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
16568 if (! DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
16569 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl); /* Potential recursion. */
16570 }
16571
16572 {
16573 tree subblock;
16574
16575 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
16576 subblock != NULL_TREE;
16577 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
16578 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
16579 }
16580 }
16581 }
16582
16583 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
16584 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
16585 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
16586 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
16587 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
16588 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
16589 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
16590 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
16591 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
16592 point to themselves. */
16593
16594 static void
16595 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
16596 {
16597 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
16598 {
16599 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
16600 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
16601 {
16602 tree arg;
16603
16604 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
16605 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
16606 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
16607 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
16608 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
16609 }
16610 }
16611 }
16612 \f
16613 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, and a boolean value to set the
16614 "abstract" flags to, set that value into the BLOCK_ABSTRACT flag for
16615 the given block, and for all local decls and all local sub-blocks
16616 (recursively) which are contained therein. */
16617
16618 static void
16619 set_block_abstract_flags (tree stmt, int setting)
16620 {
16621 tree local_decl;
16622 tree subblock;
16623 unsigned int i;
16624
16625 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) = setting;
16626
16627 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
16628 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
16629 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
16630 if (! DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
16631 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, setting);
16632
16633 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
16634 {
16635 local_decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
16636 if ((TREE_CODE (local_decl) == VAR_DECL && !TREE_STATIC (local_decl))
16637 || TREE_CODE (local_decl) == PARM_DECL)
16638 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, setting);
16639 }
16640
16641 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
16642 subblock != NULL_TREE;
16643 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
16644 set_block_abstract_flags (subblock, setting);
16645 }
16646
16647 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, and a boolean value to set the
16648 "abstract" flags to, set that value into the DECL_ABSTRACT flag for the
16649 given decl, and (in the case where the decl is a FUNCTION_DECL) also
16650 set the abstract flags for all of the parameters, local vars, local
16651 blocks and sub-blocks (recursively) to the same setting. */
16652
16653 static void
16654 set_decl_abstract_flags (tree decl, int setting)
16655 {
16656 DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) = setting;
16657 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
16658 {
16659 tree arg;
16660
16661 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
16662 DECL_ABSTRACT (arg) = setting;
16663 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
16664 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
16665 set_block_abstract_flags (DECL_INITIAL (decl), setting);
16666 }
16667 }
16668
16669 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
16670 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
16671
16672 static void
16673 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
16674 {
16675 dw_die_ref old_die;
16676 tree save_fn;
16677 tree context;
16678 int was_abstract;
16679 htab_t old_decl_loc_table;
16680 htab_t old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
16681 int old_call_site_count, old_tail_call_site_count;
16682 struct call_arg_loc_node *old_call_arg_locations;
16683
16684 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
16685 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
16686
16687 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
16688 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
16689 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
16690 return;
16691
16692 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
16693 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
16694 get locations in abstract instantces. */
16695 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
16696 decl_loc_table = NULL;
16697 old_cached_dw_loc_list_table = cached_dw_loc_list_table;
16698 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
16699 old_call_arg_locations = call_arg_locations;
16700 call_arg_locations = NULL;
16701 old_call_site_count = call_site_count;
16702 call_site_count = -1;
16703 old_tail_call_site_count = tail_call_site_count;
16704 tail_call_site_count = -1;
16705
16706 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
16707 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
16708 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
16709 {
16710 context = decl_class_context (decl);
16711 if (context)
16712 gen_type_die_for_member
16713 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die ());
16714 }
16715
16716 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
16717 save_fn = current_function_decl;
16718 current_function_decl = decl;
16719 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
16720
16721 was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
16722 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
16723 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
16724 if (! was_abstract)
16725 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
16726
16727 current_function_decl = save_fn;
16728 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
16729 cached_dw_loc_list_table = old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
16730 call_arg_locations = old_call_arg_locations;
16731 call_site_count = old_call_site_count;
16732 tail_call_site_count = old_tail_call_site_count;
16733 pop_cfun ();
16734 }
16735
16736 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
16737 htab_traverse.
16738
16739 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
16740 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
16741
16742 static int
16743 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16744 {
16745 tree type;
16746 dw_die_ref die;
16747
16748 type = (tree) *slot;
16749 die = lookup_type_die (type);
16750 if (die != NULL)
16751 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
16752 return 1;
16753 }
16754
16755 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
16756 through htab_traverse.
16757
16758 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
16759 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
16760 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
16761
16762 static int
16763 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (void **slot,
16764 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16765 {
16766 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
16767 dw_die_ref die;
16768
16769 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
16770 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
16771 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
16772 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
16773 if (die)
16774 {
16775 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
16776 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
16777 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (entry->var_decl);
16778 if (node && node->analyzed)
16779 {
16780 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
16781 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
16782 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
16783 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
16784 }
16785 }
16786 return 1;
16787 }
16788
16789 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
16790
16791 static void
16792 premark_used_types (void)
16793 {
16794 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
16795 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
16796 }
16797
16798 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
16799
16800 static void
16801 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
16802 {
16803 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
16804 htab_traverse (types_used_by_vars_hash,
16805 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper, NULL);
16806 }
16807
16808 /* Generate a DW_TAG_GNU_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
16809 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
16810
16811 static dw_die_ref
16812 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
16813 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
16814 {
16815 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
16816 tree block = ca_loc->block;
16817
16818 while (block
16819 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
16820 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
16821 {
16822 if (VEC_length (dw_die_ref, block_map) > BLOCK_NUMBER (block))
16823 stmt_die = VEC_index (dw_die_ref, block_map, BLOCK_NUMBER (block));
16824 if (stmt_die)
16825 break;
16826 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
16827 }
16828 if (stmt_die == NULL)
16829 stmt_die = subr_die;
16830 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site, stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
16831 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, ca_loc->label);
16832 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
16833 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_tail_call, 1);
16834 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
16835 {
16836 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
16837 if (tdie)
16838 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
16839 else
16840 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, ca_loc->symbol_ref);
16841 }
16842 return die;
16843 }
16844
16845 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
16846 block-local). */
16847
16848 static void
16849 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
16850 {
16851 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
16852 dw_die_ref subr_die;
16853 tree outer_scope;
16854 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
16855 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
16856 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
16857
16858 premark_used_types ();
16859
16860 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
16861 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
16862 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
16863 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
16864 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
16865
16866 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
16867 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
16868 {
16869 origin = NULL;
16870 gcc_assert (!old_die);
16871 }
16872
16873 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
16874 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
16875 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
16876 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
16877 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
16878 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
16879 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
16880
16881 if (origin != NULL)
16882 {
16883 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
16884
16885 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
16886 inline function. */
16887 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
16888 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
16889
16890 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
16891 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
16892 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
16893 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
16894 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
16895 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
16896 K::K". */
16897 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
16898 }
16899 else if (old_die)
16900 {
16901 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
16902 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
16903
16904 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
16905 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
16906 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
16907 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
16908 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
16909 {
16910 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
16911 something we have already output. */
16912 return;
16913 }
16914
16915 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
16916 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
16917 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
16918 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
16919 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
16920 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
16921 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
16922 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent) || context_die == NULL)
16923 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
16924 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
16925 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
16926 == (unsigned) s.line))))
16927 {
16928 subr_die = old_die;
16929
16930 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
16931 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
16932 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
16933 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
16934 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
16935 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
16936 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
16937 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
16938 }
16939 else
16940 {
16941 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
16942 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
16943 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
16944 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
16945 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
16946 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
16947 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
16948 }
16949 }
16950 else
16951 {
16952 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
16953
16954 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
16955 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
16956
16957 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
16958 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
16959 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
16960 {
16961 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
16962 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
16963 0, 0, context_die);
16964 }
16965
16966 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
16967 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
16968 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16969
16970 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
16971 }
16972
16973 if (declaration)
16974 {
16975 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
16976 {
16977 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
16978
16979 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
16980 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
16981 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
16982 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
16983 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
16984
16985 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
16986 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
16987 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
16988 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
16989
16990 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
16991 later reused to represent definition. */
16992 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
16993 }
16994 }
16995 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
16996 {
16997 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
16998 {
16999 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
17000 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
17001 else
17002 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
17003 }
17004 else
17005 {
17006 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
17007 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
17008 else
17009 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
17010 }
17011
17012 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
17013 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
17014 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17015
17016 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17017 }
17018 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
17019 {
17020 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
17021
17022 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17023 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17024
17025 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
17026 {
17027 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
17028 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
17029 {
17030 /* We have already generated the labels. */
17031 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, fde->dw_fde_begin);
17032 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, fde->dw_fde_end);
17033 }
17034 else
17035 {
17036 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
17037 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17038 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
17039 current_function_funcdef_no);
17040 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
17041 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
17042 current_function_funcdef_no);
17043 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
17044 }
17045
17046 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17047 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
17048 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
17049 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
17050 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
17051 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
17052 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
17053 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
17054 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
17055 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
17056 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
17057 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
17058
17059 {
17060 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
17061 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
17062 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
17063
17064 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
17065 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
17066 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
17067 }
17068 #endif
17069
17070 }
17071 else
17072 {
17073 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
17074 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
17075
17076 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
17077 {
17078 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17079 {
17080 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
17081 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
17082 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
17083 alignment offset. */
17084 bool range_list_added = false;
17085 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
17086 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added);
17087 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
17088 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
17089 &range_list_added);
17090 if (range_list_added)
17091 add_ranges (NULL);
17092 }
17093 else
17094 {
17095 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
17096 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
17097 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
17098 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
17099 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
17100 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
17101 sections when given "b foo". */
17102 const char *name = NULL;
17103 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
17104 dw_die_ref seg_die;
17105
17106 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
17107 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc,
17108 fde->dw_fde_begin);
17109 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc,
17110 fde->dw_fde_end);
17111
17112 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
17113 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
17114 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
17115
17116 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
17117 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
17118
17119 if (decl_name != NULL
17120 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
17121 {
17122 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
17123 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17124 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
17125
17126 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
17127 }
17128 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
17129 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
17130 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17131 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17132
17133 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
17134 add_AT_lbl_id (seg_die, DW_AT_low_pc,
17135 fde->dw_fde_second_begin);
17136 add_AT_lbl_id (seg_die, DW_AT_high_pc,
17137 fde->dw_fde_second_end);
17138 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
17139 if (want_pubnames ())
17140 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
17141 }
17142 }
17143 else
17144 {
17145 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, fde->dw_fde_begin);
17146 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, fde->dw_fde_end);
17147 }
17148 }
17149
17150 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
17151
17152 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
17153 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
17154 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
17155 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
17156 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
17157 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
17158 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
17159 function. */
17160 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
17161 {
17162 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
17163 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
17164 }
17165 else
17166 {
17167 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
17168 if (list->dw_loc_next)
17169 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
17170 else
17171 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
17172 }
17173
17174 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
17175 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
17176 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
17177 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
17178 by this displacement. */
17179 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
17180
17181 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
17182 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
17183 loc_list_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl, 2));
17184 }
17185
17186 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
17187 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17188 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
17189
17190 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
17191 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
17192 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
17193 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
17194 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
17195 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
17196 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
17197 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
17198 an ellipsis at the end. */
17199
17200 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
17201 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
17202 its formal parameters. */
17203 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17204 ;
17205 else if (declaration)
17206 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
17207 else
17208 {
17209 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
17210 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
17211 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
17212 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
17213 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
17214 : NULL;
17215
17216 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
17217 emit their relevant DIEs.
17218
17219 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
17220 as well as it being a normal function.
17221
17222 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
17223 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
17224 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
17225 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
17226 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
17227 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
17228 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
17229 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
17230 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
17231 children DIE.
17232
17233 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
17234 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
17235 {
17236 if (generic_decl_parm
17237 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
17238 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
17239 parm, subr_die,
17240 &parm);
17241 else if (parm)
17242 {
17243 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
17244
17245 if (parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
17246 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
17247 && parm_die
17248 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17249 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
17250
17251 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
17252 }
17253
17254 if (generic_decl_parm)
17255 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
17256 }
17257
17258 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
17259 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
17260 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
17261 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
17262 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
17263 parameters at all. */
17264 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
17265 {
17266 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
17267 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
17268 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
17269 }
17270 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
17271 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
17272 }
17273
17274 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
17275 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
17276 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
17277
17278 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
17279 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
17280 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
17281 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
17282 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
17283 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
17284 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
17285
17286 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
17287 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
17288 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
17289 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
17290 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
17291 constructor function. */
17292 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
17293 {
17294 int call_site_note_count = 0;
17295 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
17296
17297 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
17298 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
17299 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
17300
17301 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
17302 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
17303
17304 if (call_arg_locations && !dwarf_strict)
17305 {
17306 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
17307 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
17308 {
17309 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
17310 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
17311 rtx arg, next_arg;
17312
17313 for (arg = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note);
17314 arg; arg = next_arg)
17315 {
17316 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
17317 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
17318 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
17319
17320 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
17321 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
17322 && next_arg
17323 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
17324 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
17325 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
17326 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
17327 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
17328 if (mode == VOIDmode)
17329 {
17330 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
17331 if (mode == VOIDmode)
17332 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
17333 }
17334 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
17335 continue;
17336 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
17337 {
17338 gcc_assert (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX);
17339 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
17340 continue;
17341 }
17342 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
17343 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
17344 {
17345 gcc_assert (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX);
17346 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
17347 continue;
17348 }
17349 reg = NULL;
17350 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
17351 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
17352 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17353 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
17354 {
17355 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
17356 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
17357 get_address_mode (mem),
17358 GET_MODE (mem),
17359 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17360 }
17361 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
17362 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
17363 {
17364 tree tdecl
17365 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
17366 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
17367 if (tdie == NULL)
17368 continue;
17369 }
17370 else
17371 continue;
17372 if (reg == NULL
17373 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
17374 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
17375 continue;
17376 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
17377 VOIDmode,
17378 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17379 if (val == NULL)
17380 continue;
17381 if (die == NULL)
17382 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
17383 cdie = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter, die,
17384 NULL_TREE);
17385 if (reg != NULL)
17386 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
17387 else if (tdie != NULL)
17388 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
17389 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value, val);
17390 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
17391 {
17392 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
17393 if (mode == VOIDmode)
17394 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
17395 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
17396 0), 1),
17397 mode, VOIDmode,
17398 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17399 if (val != NULL)
17400 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value, val);
17401 }
17402 }
17403 if (die == NULL
17404 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
17405 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
17406 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
17407 {
17408 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
17409
17410 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
17411 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
17412 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
17413 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
17414 VOIDmode,
17415 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17416 if (tval)
17417 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target, tval);
17418 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
17419 {
17420 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
17421 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
17422 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
17423 VOIDmode,
17424 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17425 if (tval)
17426 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered,
17427 tval);
17428 }
17429 }
17430 if (die != NULL)
17431 {
17432 call_site_note_count++;
17433 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
17434 tail_call_site_note_count++;
17435 }
17436 }
17437 }
17438 call_arg_locations = NULL;
17439 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
17440 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
17441 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
17442 && !dwarf_strict)
17443 {
17444 if (call_site_count >= 0
17445 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
17446 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites, 1);
17447 else
17448 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites, 1);
17449 }
17450 call_site_count = -1;
17451 tail_call_site_count = -1;
17452 }
17453 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
17454 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
17455
17456 }
17457
17458 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
17459
17460 static hashval_t
17461 common_block_die_table_hash (const void *x)
17462 {
17463 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
17464 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
17465 }
17466
17467 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
17468 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
17469
17470 static int
17471 common_block_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
17472 {
17473 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
17474 const_dw_die_ref e = (const_dw_die_ref) y;
17475 return d->decl_id == e->decl_id && d->die_parent == e->die_parent;
17476 }
17477
17478 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
17479 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
17480
17481 static void
17482 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
17483 {
17484 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
17485 tree com_decl;
17486 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
17487 tree ultimate_origin;
17488 dw_die_ref var_die;
17489 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
17490 dw_die_ref origin_die;
17491 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
17492 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
17493 bool specialization_p = false;
17494
17495 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
17496 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
17497 origin = ultimate_origin;
17498 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
17499
17500 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
17501 of a data member. */
17502 if (com_decl)
17503 {
17504 dw_die_ref com_die;
17505 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
17506 die_node com_die_arg;
17507
17508 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
17509 if (var_die)
17510 {
17511 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
17512 {
17513 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2);
17514 if (loc)
17515 {
17516 if (off)
17517 {
17518 /* Optimize the common case. */
17519 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
17520 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
17521 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
17522 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
17523 == SYMBOL_REF)
17524 {
17525 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
17526 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
17527 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
17528 }
17529 else
17530 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
17531 }
17532 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
17533 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17534 }
17535 }
17536 return;
17537 }
17538
17539 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
17540 common_block_die_table
17541 = htab_create_ggc (10, common_block_die_table_hash,
17542 common_block_die_table_eq, NULL);
17543
17544 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
17545 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
17546 com_die = (dw_die_ref) htab_find (common_block_die_table, &com_die_arg);
17547 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
17548 if (com_die == NULL)
17549 {
17550 const char *cnam
17551 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
17552 void **slot;
17553
17554 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
17555 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
17556 if (loc)
17557 {
17558 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
17559 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
17560 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
17561 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
17562 }
17563 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
17564 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17565 if (want_pubnames ())
17566 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
17567 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
17568 slot = htab_find_slot (common_block_die_table, com_die, INSERT);
17569 *slot = (void *) com_die;
17570 }
17571 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
17572 {
17573 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
17574 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
17575 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17576 }
17577 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
17578 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
17579 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
17580 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
17581 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
17582 if (loc)
17583 {
17584 if (off)
17585 {
17586 /* Optimize the common case. */
17587 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
17588 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
17589 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
17590 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
17591 {
17592 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
17593 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
17594 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
17595 }
17596 else
17597 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
17598 }
17599 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
17600 }
17601 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
17602 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17603 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
17604 return;
17605 }
17606
17607 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
17608 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
17609 DIE for it again. Allow re-declarations of DECLs that are
17610 inside functions, though. */
17611 if (old_die && declaration && !local_scope_p (context_die))
17612 return;
17613
17614 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
17615 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
17616 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
17617 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
17618 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
17619 else
17620 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
17621
17622 origin_die = NULL;
17623 if (origin != NULL)
17624 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
17625
17626 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
17627 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
17628
17629 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
17630 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
17631 sharing them.
17632
17633 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
17634
17635 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
17636 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
17637 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
17638 declaration. */
17639 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
17640 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
17641 {
17642 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
17643 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
17644 specialization_p = true;
17645 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
17646 {
17647 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
17648 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
17649
17650 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
17651 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
17652
17653 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
17654 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
17655
17656 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
17657 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
17658 }
17659 }
17660 else
17661 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
17662
17663 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
17664 || (origin != NULL
17665 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
17666 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
17667 decl_function_context
17668 (decl_or_origin))))
17669 {
17670 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
17671
17672 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
17673 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
17674 else
17675 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl_or_origin),
17676 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
17677 }
17678
17679 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
17680 {
17681 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
17682 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
17683
17684 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17685 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17686
17687 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
17688 }
17689
17690 if (declaration)
17691 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17692
17693 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration || old_die == NULL))
17694 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
17695
17696 if (! declaration
17697 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
17698 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
17699 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
17700 already set. */
17701 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
17702 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
17703 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
17704 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
17705 to add it again. */
17706 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
17707 {
17708 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
17709 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
17710 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
17711 else
17712 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
17713 decl == NULL, DW_AT_location);
17714 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
17715 }
17716 else
17717 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
17718 }
17719
17720 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
17721
17722 static void
17723 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17724 {
17725 dw_die_ref const_die;
17726 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
17727
17728 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
17729 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
17730 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, 1, 0, context_die);
17731 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
17732 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
17733 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17734 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17735 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
17736 }
17737
17738 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
17739
17740 static void
17741 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17742 {
17743 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17744 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
17745 rtx insn;
17746 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17747
17748 if (origin != NULL)
17749 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
17750 else
17751 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
17752
17753 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
17754 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
17755 else
17756 {
17757 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
17758
17759 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
17760 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
17761 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
17762 if (insn
17763 && (LABEL_P (insn)
17764 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
17765 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
17766 {
17767 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
17768 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
17769 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
17770 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
17771 it if it ever does happen. */
17772 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
17773
17774 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
17775 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
17776 }
17777 else if (insn
17778 && NOTE_P (insn)
17779 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
17780 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
17781 {
17782 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
17783 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
17784 }
17785 }
17786 }
17787
17788 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
17789 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
17790 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
17791
17792 static inline void
17793 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
17794 {
17795 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
17796
17797 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17798 {
17799 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
17800 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
17801 }
17802 }
17803
17804
17805 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
17806 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
17807
17808 static inline void
17809 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
17810 {
17811 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17812
17813 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
17814 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17815 {
17816 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
17817 dw_die_ref pdie;
17818 dw_attr_ref attr = NULL;
17819
17820 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
17821 {
17822 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
17823 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
17824 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
17825 }
17826
17827 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
17828 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
17829 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
17830 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
17831 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
17832 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
17833 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
17834 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
17835 {
17836 dw_attr_ref new_attr;
17837
17838 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
17839 if (pdie == NULL)
17840 break;
17841 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
17842 break;
17843 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
17844 if (new_attr == NULL
17845 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
17846 break;
17847 attr = new_attr;
17848 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
17849 }
17850 if (attr != NULL
17851 && (ranges_table[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
17852 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE].num
17853 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
17854 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
17855 {
17856 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
17857 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
17858 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
17859 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
17860 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
17861 {
17862 ++supercnt;
17863 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt].num
17864 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
17865 }
17866 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
17867 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
17868 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
17869 ++thiscnt;
17870 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
17871 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges,
17872 (off + supercnt - thiscnt)
17873 * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
17874 return;
17875 }
17876
17877 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
17878
17879 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
17880 do
17881 {
17882 add_ranges (chain);
17883 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
17884 }
17885 while (chain);
17886 add_ranges (NULL);
17887 }
17888 else
17889 {
17890 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
17891 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
17892 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
17893 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
17894 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
17895 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
17896 }
17897 }
17898
17899 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
17900
17901 static void
17902 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
17903 {
17904 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
17905
17906 if (call_arg_locations)
17907 {
17908 if (VEC_length (dw_die_ref, block_map) <= BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt))
17909 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_die_ref, heap, block_map,
17910 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt) + 1);
17911 VEC_replace (dw_die_ref, block_map, BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt), stmt_die);
17912 }
17913
17914 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
17915 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
17916
17917 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
17918 }
17919
17920 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
17921
17922 static void
17923 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
17924 {
17925 tree decl;
17926
17927 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
17928 be abstract. */
17929 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
17930
17931 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
17932
17933 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
17934 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
17935 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
17936 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
17937 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
17938
17939 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
17940 {
17941 dw_die_ref subr_die
17942 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
17943
17944 if (call_arg_locations)
17945 {
17946 if (VEC_length (dw_die_ref, block_map) <= BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt))
17947 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_die_ref, heap, block_map,
17948 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt) + 1);
17949 VEC_replace (dw_die_ref, block_map, BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt), subr_die);
17950 }
17951 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
17952 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
17953 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
17954 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
17955
17956 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
17957 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
17958 }
17959 }
17960
17961 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
17962
17963 static void
17964 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17965 {
17966 dw_die_ref decl_die;
17967
17968 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
17969 return;
17970
17971 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
17972 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
17973 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
17974 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
17975 context_die);
17976
17977 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
17978 {
17979 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
17980 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
17981 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
17982 }
17983
17984 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
17985 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
17986
17987 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17988 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17989
17990 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
17991
17992 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
17993 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
17994 }
17995
17996 #if 0
17997 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
17998 Use modified_type_die instead.
17999 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
18000 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
18001
18002 static void
18003 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18004 {
18005 dw_die_ref ptr_die
18006 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18007
18008 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
18009 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18010 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
18011 }
18012
18013 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
18014 Use modified_type_die instead.
18015 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
18016 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
18017
18018 static void
18019 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18020 {
18021 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
18022
18023 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
18024 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
18025 else
18026 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
18027
18028 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
18029 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18030 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
18031 }
18032 #endif
18033
18034 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
18035
18036 static void
18037 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18038 {
18039 dw_die_ref ptr_die
18040 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
18041 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18042
18043 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
18044 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18045 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
18046 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18047 }
18048
18049 typedef const char *dchar_p; /* For DEF_VEC_P. */
18050 DEF_VEC_P(dchar_p);
18051 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dchar_p,heap);
18052
18053 static char *producer_string;
18054
18055 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
18056 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
18057
18058 static char *
18059 gen_producer_string (void)
18060 {
18061 size_t j;
18062 VEC(dchar_p, heap) *switches = NULL;
18063 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
18064 char *producer, *tail;
18065 const char *p;
18066 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
18067 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
18068
18069 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
18070 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
18071 {
18072 case OPT_o:
18073 case OPT_d:
18074 case OPT_dumpbase:
18075 case OPT_dumpdir:
18076 case OPT_auxbase:
18077 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
18078 case OPT_quiet:
18079 case OPT_version:
18080 case OPT_v:
18081 case OPT_w:
18082 case OPT_L:
18083 case OPT_D:
18084 case OPT_I:
18085 case OPT_U:
18086 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
18087 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
18088 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
18089 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
18090 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
18091 case OPT_gno_record_gcc_switches:
18092 case OPT__output_pch_:
18093 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
18094 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
18095 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
18096 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
18097 case OPT____:
18098 case OPT__sysroot_:
18099 case OPT_nostdinc:
18100 case OPT_nostdinc__:
18101 /* Ignore these. */
18102 continue;
18103 default:
18104 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
18105 == '-');
18106 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
18107 {
18108 case 'M':
18109 case 'i':
18110 case 'W':
18111 continue;
18112 case 'f':
18113 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
18114 "dump", 4) == 0)
18115 continue;
18116 break;
18117 default:
18118 break;
18119 }
18120 VEC_safe_push (dchar_p, heap, switches,
18121 save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
18122 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
18123 break;
18124 }
18125
18126 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
18127 tail = producer;
18128 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
18129 tail += plen;
18130
18131 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dchar_p, switches, j, p)
18132 {
18133 len = strlen (p);
18134 *tail = ' ';
18135 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
18136 tail += len + 1;
18137 }
18138
18139 *tail = '\0';
18140 VEC_free (dchar_p, heap, switches);
18141 return producer;
18142 }
18143
18144 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
18145
18146 static dw_die_ref
18147 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
18148 {
18149 dw_die_ref die;
18150 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
18151 int language;
18152
18153 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
18154
18155 if (filename)
18156 {
18157 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
18158 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
18159 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
18160 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
18161 }
18162
18163 if (producer_string == NULL)
18164 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
18165 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string);
18166
18167 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
18168 from the global list of translation units. */
18169 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
18170 {
18171 unsigned i;
18172 tree t;
18173 const char *common_lang = NULL;
18174
18175 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (tree, all_translation_units, i, t)
18176 {
18177 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
18178 continue;
18179 if (!common_lang)
18180 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
18181 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
18182 ;
18183 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
18184 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
18185 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
18186 common_lang = "GNU C++";
18187 else
18188 {
18189 /* Fall back to C. */
18190 common_lang = NULL;
18191 break;
18192 }
18193 }
18194
18195 if (common_lang)
18196 language_string = common_lang;
18197 }
18198
18199 language = DW_LANG_C89;
18200 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
18201 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
18202 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
18203 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
18204 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
18205 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
18206 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18207 {
18208 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
18209 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
18210 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
18211 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
18212 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
18213 language = DW_LANG_Java;
18214 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
18215 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
18216 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
18217 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
18218 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
18219 {
18220 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
18221 language = DW_LANG_Go;
18222 }
18223 }
18224 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
18225 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
18226 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
18227
18228 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
18229
18230 switch (language)
18231 {
18232 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
18233 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
18234 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
18235 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
18236 lowercases everything. */
18237 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
18238 break;
18239 default:
18240 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
18241 break;
18242 }
18243 return die;
18244 }
18245
18246 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
18247
18248 static void
18249 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
18250 {
18251 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
18252
18253 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
18254 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
18255
18256 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
18257 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
18258
18259 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
18260 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
18261 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
18262 if (access == access_public_node)
18263 {
18264 if (dwarf_version == 2
18265 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
18266 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
18267 }
18268 else if (access == access_protected_node)
18269 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18270 else if (dwarf_version > 2
18271 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
18272 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18273 }
18274
18275 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
18276
18277 static void
18278 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18279 {
18280 tree member;
18281 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
18282 dw_die_ref child;
18283
18284 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
18285 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
18286 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
18287 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
18288 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
18289 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
18290 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
18291 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
18292 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
18293 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
18294 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
18295
18296 /* First output info about the base classes. */
18297 if (binfo)
18298 {
18299 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
18300 int i;
18301 tree base;
18302
18303 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
18304 gen_inheritance_die (base,
18305 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
18306 : access_public_node), context_die);
18307 }
18308
18309 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
18310 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
18311 {
18312 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
18313 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
18314 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
18315 do put them in the right order. */
18316
18317 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
18318 if (child)
18319 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
18320 else
18321 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
18322 }
18323
18324 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
18325 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
18326 {
18327 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
18328 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
18329 continue;
18330
18331 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
18332 if (child)
18333 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
18334 else
18335 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
18336 }
18337 }
18338
18339 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
18340 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
18341 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
18342
18343 static void
18344 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
18345 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18346 {
18347 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18348 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
18349 int nested = 0;
18350 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
18351 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18352 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
18353 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
18354 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
18355
18356 if (type_die && ! complete)
18357 return;
18358
18359 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
18360 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
18361 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
18362 nested = 1;
18363
18364 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
18365
18366 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
18367 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
18368 {
18369 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
18370
18371 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
18372 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
18373 scope_die, type);
18374 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18375 if (old_die)
18376 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
18377 else
18378 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
18379 }
18380 else
18381 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18382
18383 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
18384 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
18385 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type))
18386 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
18387
18388 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
18389 then give a list of members. */
18390 if (complete && !ns_decl)
18391 {
18392 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
18393 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
18394 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18395 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
18396 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
18397 {
18398 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18399 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18400 }
18401
18402 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
18403 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
18404 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
18405 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
18406
18407 push_decl_scope (type);
18408 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
18409 pop_decl_scope ();
18410
18411 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
18412 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
18413 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18414
18415 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
18416 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
18417 {
18418 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
18419
18420 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
18421 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18422 lookup_type_die (vtype));
18423 }
18424 }
18425 else
18426 {
18427 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18428
18429 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
18430 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18431 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
18432 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
18433 }
18434
18435 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18436 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
18437 }
18438
18439 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
18440
18441 static void
18442 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18443 {
18444 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
18445 dw_die_ref subr_die
18446 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
18447 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18448
18449 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
18450 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
18451 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
18452 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
18453
18454 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
18455 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
18456 }
18457
18458 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
18459
18460 static void
18461 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18462 {
18463 dw_die_ref type_die;
18464 tree origin;
18465
18466 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
18467 return;
18468
18469 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
18470 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
18471 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18472 if (origin != NULL)
18473 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
18474 else
18475 {
18476 tree type;
18477
18478 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
18479 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
18480 {
18481 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
18482
18483 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
18484 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
18485 }
18486 else
18487 {
18488 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18489
18490 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18491 {
18492 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
18493 an anonymous type, e.g:
18494 typedef struct {...} foo;
18495 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
18496 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
18497 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
18498 the C++ FE.
18499
18500 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
18501 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
18502 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
18503 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
18504 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
18505 anonymous struct DIE. */
18506 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18507 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18508
18509 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
18510 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
18511 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
18512 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
18513 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
18514 this debug info. */
18515 add_linkage_attr (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
18516 }
18517 }
18518
18519 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
18520 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18521
18522 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
18523 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
18524 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
18525 created. */
18526 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18527
18528 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
18529 }
18530
18531 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18532 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
18533
18534 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18535 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
18536 }
18537
18538 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
18539
18540 static void
18541 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
18542 dw_die_ref context_die,
18543 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18544 {
18545 int need_pop;
18546
18547 if (type == NULL_TREE
18548 || !is_tagged_type (type))
18549 return;
18550
18551 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
18552 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
18553 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
18554 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
18555 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
18556 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
18557 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
18558 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
18559 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
18560 {
18561 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
18562
18563 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18564 return;
18565
18566 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
18567 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18568 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18569 need_pop = 1;
18570 }
18571 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
18572 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
18573 {
18574 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
18575 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
18576 decls_for_scope. */
18577 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18578 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
18579 specification. */
18580 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
18581 context_die = NULL;
18582 need_pop = 0;
18583 }
18584 else
18585 {
18586 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
18587 need_pop = 0;
18588 }
18589
18590 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
18591 {
18592 /* This might have been written out by the call to
18593 declare_in_namespace. */
18594 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18595 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
18596 }
18597 else
18598 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
18599
18600 if (need_pop)
18601 pop_decl_scope ();
18602
18603 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
18604 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
18605 when appropriate. */
18606 }
18607
18608 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
18609
18610 static void
18611 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
18612 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18613 {
18614 struct array_descr_info info;
18615
18616 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
18617 return;
18618
18619 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
18620 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
18621 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
18622 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18623 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
18624 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
18625 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
18626 type. */
18627 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
18628
18629 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
18630 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
18631 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
18632 {
18633 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18634 return;
18635
18636 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
18637 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
18638
18639 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
18640 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
18641
18642 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18643
18644 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
18645 return;
18646 }
18647
18648 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
18649 generate debug info for the typedef. */
18650 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18651 {
18652 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
18653 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
18654 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
18655 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
18656 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
18657
18658 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
18659 return;
18660 }
18661
18662 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
18663 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
18664 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
18665 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info)
18666 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18667 {
18668 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
18669 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18670 return;
18671 }
18672
18673 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
18674 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
18675 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
18676 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
18677 cloned type itself). */
18678 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
18679 type = type_main_variant (type);
18680
18681 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18682 return;
18683
18684 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
18685 {
18686 case ERROR_MARK:
18687 break;
18688
18689 case POINTER_TYPE:
18690 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
18691 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
18692 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
18693 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
18694 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
18695 statement. */
18696 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18697
18698 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
18699 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
18700 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18701 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18702 break;
18703
18704 case OFFSET_TYPE:
18705 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
18706 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
18707 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
18708 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18709
18710 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
18711 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18712 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18713
18714 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
18715 itself. */
18716 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
18717 break;
18718
18719 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
18720 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
18721 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18722 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18723 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
18724 break;
18725
18726 case METHOD_TYPE:
18727 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
18728 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18729 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18730 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
18731 break;
18732
18733 case ARRAY_TYPE:
18734 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
18735 break;
18736
18737 case VECTOR_TYPE:
18738 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
18739 break;
18740
18741 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
18742 case RECORD_TYPE:
18743 case UNION_TYPE:
18744 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
18745 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
18746 return;
18747
18748 case VOID_TYPE:
18749 case INTEGER_TYPE:
18750 case REAL_TYPE:
18751 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
18752 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
18753 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
18754 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
18755 break;
18756
18757 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
18758 case LANG_TYPE:
18759 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
18760 {
18761 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18762 if (type_die == NULL)
18763 {
18764 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
18765 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
18766 name = DECL_NAME (name);
18767 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
18768 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
18769 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18770 }
18771 }
18772 break;
18773
18774 default:
18775 gcc_unreachable ();
18776 }
18777
18778 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18779 }
18780
18781 static void
18782 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18783 {
18784 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18785 }
18786
18787 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
18788 things which are local to the given block. */
18789
18790 static void
18791 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18792 {
18793 int must_output_die = 0;
18794 bool inlined_func;
18795
18796 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
18797 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
18798 return;
18799
18800 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
18801
18802 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
18803 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
18804 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
18805 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
18806 {
18807 tree sub;
18808
18809 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
18810 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
18811
18812 return;
18813 }
18814
18815 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
18816 block. */
18817 if (inlined_func)
18818 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
18819 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
18820 must_output_die = 1;
18821 else
18822 {
18823 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
18824 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
18825 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18826 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
18827 as being a "significant" one. */
18828 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
18829 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
18830 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
18831 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
18832 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
18833 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
18834 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
18835 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18836 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
18837 must_output_die = 1;
18838 }
18839
18840 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
18841 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
18842 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
18843 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
18844 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
18845 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
18846 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
18847 if (must_output_die)
18848 {
18849 if (inlined_func)
18850 {
18851 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
18852 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
18853 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
18854 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
18855 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
18856 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
18857 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
18858 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
18859
18860 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
18861 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
18862 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
18863 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
18864 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18865 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
18866 }
18867 else
18868 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
18869 }
18870 else
18871 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
18872 }
18873
18874 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
18875 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
18876 static void
18877 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
18878 {
18879 dw_die_ref die;
18880 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
18881
18882 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18883 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
18884 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
18885 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
18886 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
18887 else
18888 die = NULL;
18889
18890 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
18891 add_child_die (context_die, die);
18892 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
18893 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
18894 stmt, context_die);
18895 else
18896 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
18897 }
18898
18899 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
18900 all of its sub-blocks. */
18901
18902 static void
18903 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18904 {
18905 tree decl;
18906 unsigned int i;
18907 tree subblocks;
18908
18909 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
18910 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
18911 return;
18912
18913 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
18914 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
18915 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
18916 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
18917 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
18918 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
18919 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
18920 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
18921 context_die);
18922
18923 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
18924 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18925 return;
18926
18927 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
18928 therein) of this block. */
18929 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
18930 subblocks != NULL;
18931 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
18932 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
18933 }
18934
18935 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
18936
18937 static inline int
18938 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
18939 {
18940 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
18941 return 1;
18942
18943 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
18944 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
18945 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
18946 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
18947 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
18948 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
18949 return 1;
18950
18951 return 0;
18952 }
18953
18954 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
18955 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
18956 constructs like:
18957
18958 typedef struct {...} foo;
18959
18960 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
18961 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
18962 struct type. */
18963
18964 static bool
18965 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
18966 {
18967 if (decl == NULL_TREE
18968 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
18969 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
18970 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
18971 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
18972 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
18973 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
18974 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
18975 || !is_cxx ())
18976 return FALSE;
18977
18978 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
18979 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
18980 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
18981 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
18982 }
18983
18984 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
18985
18986 static inline dw_die_ref
18987 get_context_die (tree context)
18988 {
18989 if (context)
18990 {
18991 /* Find die that represents this context. */
18992 if (TYPE_P (context))
18993 {
18994 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
18995 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
18996 }
18997 else
18998 return force_decl_die (context);
18999 }
19000 return comp_unit_die ();
19001 }
19002
19003 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
19004
19005 static dw_die_ref
19006 force_decl_die (tree decl)
19007 {
19008 dw_die_ref decl_die;
19009 unsigned saved_external_flag;
19010 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
19011 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19012 if (!decl_die)
19013 {
19014 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19015
19016 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19017 if (decl_die)
19018 return decl_die;
19019
19020 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
19021 {
19022 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19023 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
19024 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
19025 declaration die. */
19026 save_fn = current_function_decl;
19027 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
19028 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
19029 current_function_decl = save_fn;
19030 break;
19031
19032 case VAR_DECL:
19033 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
19034 gen_decl_die() call. */
19035 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
19036 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
19037 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
19038 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
19039 break;
19040
19041 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19042 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19043 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19044 else
19045 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
19046 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
19047 break;
19048
19049 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
19050 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
19051 break;
19052
19053 default:
19054 gcc_unreachable ();
19055 }
19056
19057 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
19058 if (!decl_die)
19059 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19060 gcc_assert (decl_die);
19061 }
19062
19063 return decl_die;
19064 }
19065
19066 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
19067 always returned. */
19068
19069 static dw_die_ref
19070 force_type_die (tree type)
19071 {
19072 dw_die_ref type_die;
19073
19074 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19075 if (!type_die)
19076 {
19077 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
19078
19079 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
19080 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
19081 gcc_assert (type_die);
19082 }
19083 return type_die;
19084 }
19085
19086 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
19087 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
19088
19089 static dw_die_ref
19090 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
19091 {
19092 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
19093 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
19094 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19095 /* Force out the namespace. */
19096 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
19097
19098 return context_die;
19099 }
19100
19101 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
19102 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
19103
19104 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
19105 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
19106
19107 static dw_die_ref
19108 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
19109 {
19110 dw_die_ref ns_context;
19111
19112 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19113 return context_die;
19114
19115 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
19116 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
19117 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
19118 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
19119 return context_die;
19120
19121 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
19122
19123 if (ns_context != context_die)
19124 {
19125 if (is_fortran ())
19126 return ns_context;
19127 if (DECL_P (thing))
19128 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
19129 else
19130 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
19131 }
19132 return context_die;
19133 }
19134
19135 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
19136
19137 static void
19138 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19139 {
19140 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
19141
19142 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
19143 they are an alias of. */
19144 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
19145 {
19146 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
19147 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
19148 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
19149 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
19150 context_die, decl);
19151 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
19152 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19153 {
19154 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
19155 if (name)
19156 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
19157 }
19158 else
19159 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
19160 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19161 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19162 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
19163 }
19164 else
19165 {
19166 /* Output a namespace alias. */
19167
19168 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
19169 dw_die_ref origin_die
19170 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
19171
19172 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
19173 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19174 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
19175 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
19176 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
19177 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
19178 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
19179 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
19180 }
19181 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
19182 if (want_pubnames ())
19183 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
19184 }
19185
19186 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
19187 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
19188 for all other decls it returns NULL. */
19189
19190 static dw_die_ref
19191 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19192 {
19193 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19194 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
19195
19196 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
19197 return NULL;
19198
19199 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
19200 {
19201 case ERROR_MARK:
19202 break;
19203
19204 case CONST_DECL:
19205 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
19206 {
19207 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
19208 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
19209 break;
19210 }
19211
19212 /* Emit its type. */
19213 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
19214
19215 /* And its containing namespace. */
19216 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
19217
19218 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
19219 break;
19220
19221 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19222 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
19223 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
19224 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
19225 && DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl_or_origin)
19226 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
19227 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
19228 break;
19229
19230 #if 0
19231 /* FIXME */
19232 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
19233 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
19234 if (current_function_decl != decl)
19235 /* This is only a declaration. */;
19236 #endif
19237
19238 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
19239 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
19240 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
19241 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
19242 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
19243
19244 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
19245 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
19246 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
19247 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
19248 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
19249 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
19250 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
19251 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
19252 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19253 {
19254 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
19255 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
19256 }
19257
19258 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
19259 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19260 {
19261 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
19262 have its containing type. */
19263 if (!origin)
19264 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
19265 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
19266 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
19267
19268 /* And its return type. */
19269 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
19270
19271 /* And its virtual context. */
19272 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19273 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
19274
19275 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
19276 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
19277 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
19278
19279 /* And its containing namespace. */
19280 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
19281 }
19282
19283 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
19284 if (decl)
19285 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
19286 break;
19287
19288 case TYPE_DECL:
19289 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19290 actual typedefs. */
19291 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19292 break;
19293
19294 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
19295 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
19296 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
19297 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
19298 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
19299 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
19300 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
19301 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
19302 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
19303 case. */
19304 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19305 break;
19306
19307 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
19308 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
19309 else
19310 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
19311 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
19312 break;
19313
19314 case LABEL_DECL:
19315 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
19316 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
19317 break;
19318
19319 case VAR_DECL:
19320 case RESULT_DECL:
19321 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19322 variable declarations or definitions. */
19323 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19324 break;
19325
19326 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
19327 object. */
19328 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
19329 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
19330 else
19331 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19332
19333 /* And its containing type. */
19334 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
19335 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
19336 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
19337
19338 /* And its containing namespace. */
19339 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
19340
19341 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
19342 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
19343 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
19344 function. */
19345 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
19346 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
19347 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
19348 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
19349 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19350 context_die);
19351 else
19352 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
19353 break;
19354
19355 case FIELD_DECL:
19356 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
19357 anonymous unions and structs. */
19358 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
19359 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
19360 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
19361 {
19362 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
19363 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
19364 }
19365 break;
19366
19367 case PARM_DECL:
19368 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
19369 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
19370 else
19371 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19372 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
19373 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19374 context_die);
19375
19376 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19377 case IMPORTED_DECL:
19378 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19379 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
19380 break;
19381
19382 default:
19383 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
19384 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
19385 break;
19386 }
19387
19388 return NULL;
19389 }
19390 \f
19391 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
19392 compilation proper has finished. */
19393
19394 static void
19395 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
19396 {
19397 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
19398 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
19399 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
19400 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
19401 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19402 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19403 }
19404
19405 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
19406 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
19407 static void
19408 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
19409 {
19410 if (!local)
19411 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19412 }
19413
19414 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
19415 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
19416 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
19417 that DECL belongs to.
19418 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
19419 static void
19420 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
19421 tree name,
19422 tree lexical_block,
19423 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
19424 {
19425 expanded_location xloc;
19426 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
19427 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
19428
19429 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
19430 {
19431 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
19432 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
19433 gcc_assert (decl);
19434 }
19435 else
19436 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
19437
19438 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
19439 {
19440 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19441 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
19442 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
19443 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
19444 if (!at_import_die)
19445 {
19446 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
19447 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
19448 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19449 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
19450 }
19451 }
19452 else
19453 {
19454 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19455 if (!at_import_die)
19456 {
19457 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
19458 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
19459 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
19460 {
19461 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
19462
19463 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
19464 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19465 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
19466 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19467 return;
19468 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
19469 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
19470 }
19471 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
19472 }
19473 }
19474
19475 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19476 {
19477 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19478 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
19479 lexical_block_die,
19480 lexical_block);
19481 else
19482 return;
19483 }
19484 else
19485 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
19486 lexical_block_die,
19487 lexical_block);
19488
19489 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
19490 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
19491 if (name)
19492 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
19493 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
19494 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
19495 }
19496
19497 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
19498 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
19499 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
19500 importing whole module. */
19501
19502 static void
19503 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
19504 bool child)
19505 {
19506 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
19507 dw_die_ref scope_die;
19508
19509 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19510 return;
19511
19512 gcc_assert (decl);
19513
19514 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
19515 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
19516 itself. */
19517
19518 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
19519 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
19520 if (context
19521 && TYPE_P (context)
19522 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19523 return;
19524
19525 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19526 return;
19527
19528 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
19529
19530 if (child)
19531 {
19532 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
19533 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
19534 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
19535 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
19536 }
19537
19538 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
19539 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
19540
19541 }
19542
19543 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
19544
19545 void
19546 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
19547 {
19548 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
19549
19550 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
19551 {
19552 case ERROR_MARK:
19553 return;
19554
19555 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19556 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
19557 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
19558 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
19559 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
19560 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
19561 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
19562 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
19563 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
19564 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
19565 with the definition of the function.
19566
19567 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
19568 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
19569 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
19570 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
19571 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
19572 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
19573 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
19574 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
19575 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
19576 that they *are* definitions).
19577
19578 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
19579 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
19580 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
19581 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
19582 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
19583 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
19584 return;
19585
19586 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
19587 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
19588 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
19589 if (decl_function_context (decl)
19590 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
19591 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19592 context_die = NULL;
19593 break;
19594
19595 case VAR_DECL:
19596 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
19597 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
19598 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
19599 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
19600 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
19601 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
19602 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
19603 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
19604 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
19605 return;
19606
19607 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
19608 if (TREE_STATIC (decl)
19609 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
19610 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19611 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19612
19613 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19614 variable declarations or definitions. */
19615 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19616 return;
19617 break;
19618
19619 case CONST_DECL:
19620 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19621 return;
19622 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
19623 return;
19624 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
19625 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19626 break;
19627
19628 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19629 case IMPORTED_DECL:
19630 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19631 return;
19632 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
19633 return;
19634 break;
19635
19636 case TYPE_DECL:
19637 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
19638 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
19639 return;
19640
19641 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
19642 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
19643 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
19644 return;
19645
19646 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
19647 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19648 return;
19649
19650 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
19651 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
19652 if (decl_function_context (decl))
19653 context_die = NULL;
19654
19655 break;
19656
19657 default:
19658 return;
19659 }
19660
19661 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
19662 }
19663
19664 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
19665
19666 static void
19667 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
19668 {
19669 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19670 call_arg_locations = NULL;
19671 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
19672 call_site_count = -1;
19673 tail_call_site_count = -1;
19674 VEC_free (dw_die_ref, heap, block_map);
19675 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
19676 htab_empty (cached_dw_loc_list_table);
19677 }
19678
19679 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
19680 a lexical block. */
19681
19682 static void
19683 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
19684 unsigned int blocknum)
19685 {
19686 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
19687 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
19688 }
19689
19690 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
19691 lexical block. */
19692
19693 static void
19694 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
19695 {
19696 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
19697 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
19698 }
19699
19700 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
19701 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
19702
19703 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
19704 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
19705 we may end up calling them anyway. */
19706
19707 static bool
19708 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
19709 {
19710 tree decl;
19711 unsigned int i;
19712
19713 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
19714 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
19715 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
19716 return 0;
19717 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
19718 {
19719 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
19720 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
19721 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
19722 return 0;
19723 }
19724
19725 return 1;
19726 }
19727
19728 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
19729
19730 static int
19731 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
19732 {
19733 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p1 =
19734 (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p1_p;
19735 const char *const p2 = (const char *) p2_p;
19736 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
19737 }
19738
19739 static hashval_t
19740 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
19741 {
19742 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p = (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p_p;
19743 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
19744 }
19745
19746 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
19747 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
19748 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
19749 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
19750 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
19751 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
19752 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
19753 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
19754 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
19755 all searches. */
19756
19757 static struct dwarf_file_data *
19758 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
19759 {
19760 void ** slot;
19761 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
19762
19763 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
19764 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
19765 if (file_table_last_lookup
19766 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
19767 || filename_cmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
19768 return file_table_last_lookup;
19769
19770 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
19771 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
19772 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
19773 if (*slot)
19774 return (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
19775
19776 created = ggc_alloc_dwarf_file_data ();
19777 created->filename = file_name;
19778 created->emitted_number = 0;
19779 *slot = created;
19780 return created;
19781 }
19782
19783 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
19784 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
19785 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
19786 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
19787 types, which may include filenames. */
19788
19789 static int
19790 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
19791 {
19792 if (! fd->emitted_number)
19793 {
19794 if (last_emitted_file)
19795 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
19796 else
19797 fd->emitted_number = 1;
19798 last_emitted_file = fd;
19799
19800 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
19801 {
19802 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
19803 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
19804 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
19805 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
19806 }
19807 }
19808
19809 return fd->emitted_number;
19810 }
19811
19812 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
19813 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
19814 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
19815
19816 static void
19817 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
19818 {
19819 die_arg_entry entry;
19820
19821 if (!die || !arg)
19822 return;
19823
19824 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
19825 tmpl_value_parm_die_table
19826 = VEC_alloc (die_arg_entry, gc, 32);
19827
19828 entry.die = die;
19829 entry.arg = arg;
19830 VEC_safe_push (die_arg_entry, gc,
19831 tmpl_value_parm_die_table,
19832 &entry);
19833 }
19834
19835 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
19836 otherwise. */
19837
19838 static bool
19839 generic_type_p (tree t)
19840 {
19841 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
19842 return false;
19843 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
19844 }
19845
19846 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
19847 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
19848 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
19849
19850 static void
19851 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
19852 {
19853 if (!generic_type_p (t))
19854 return;
19855
19856 if (generic_type_instances == NULL)
19857 generic_type_instances = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
19858
19859 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, generic_type_instances, t);
19860 }
19861
19862 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
19863 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
19864 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
19865
19866 static void
19867 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
19868 {
19869 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
19870 {
19871 unsigned i;
19872 die_arg_entry *e;
19873
19874 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (die_arg_entry, tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
19875 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
19876 }
19877 }
19878
19879 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
19880 that have been previously scheduled by
19881 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
19882 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
19883
19884 static void
19885 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
19886 {
19887 unsigned i;
19888 tree t;
19889
19890 if (generic_type_instances == NULL)
19891 return;
19892
19893 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (tree, generic_type_instances, i, t)
19894 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
19895 }
19896
19897
19898 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
19899
19900 static void
19901 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
19902 {
19903 dw_die_ref die;
19904 dw_attr_ref attr;
19905 const char *dname;
19906
19907 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
19908 if (!die)
19909 return;
19910
19911 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
19912 if (!dname)
19913 return;
19914
19915 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
19916 if (attr)
19917 {
19918 struct indirect_string_node *node;
19919
19920 node = find_AT_string (dname);
19921 /* replace the string. */
19922 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
19923 }
19924
19925 else
19926 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
19927 }
19928
19929 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
19930 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
19931 our lookup table. */
19932
19933 static void
19934 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
19935 {
19936 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
19937 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
19938 rtx next_real, next_note;
19939 static const char *last_label;
19940 static const char *last_postcall_label;
19941 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
19942 static rtx expected_next_loc_note;
19943 tree decl;
19944 bool var_loc_p;
19945
19946 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
19947 {
19948 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
19949 {
19950 call_site_count++;
19951 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
19952 tail_call_site_count++;
19953 }
19954 return;
19955 }
19956
19957 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
19958 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
19959 return;
19960
19961 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
19962 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
19963 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
19964 calculation for next time. */
19965 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
19966 if (next_real)
19967 {
19968 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
19969 next_real = NULL_RTX;
19970 }
19971
19972 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
19973 if (! next_note
19974 || INSN_DELETED_P (next_note)
19975 || GET_CODE (next_note) != NOTE
19976 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
19977 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
19978 next_note = NULL_RTX;
19979
19980 if (! next_real)
19981 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
19982
19983 if (next_note)
19984 {
19985 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
19986 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
19987 }
19988 else
19989 cached_next_real_insn = NULL_RTX;
19990
19991 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
19992 don't do anything. */
19993 if (var_loc_p
19994 && next_real == NULL_RTX
19995 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
19996 return;
19997
19998 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
19999 next_real = get_last_insn ();
20000
20001 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
20002 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
20003 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
20004 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
20005 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
20006 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
20007 {
20008 last_label = NULL;
20009 last_postcall_label = NULL;
20010 }
20011
20012 if (var_loc_p)
20013 {
20014 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
20015 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
20016 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
20017 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
20018 if (newloc == NULL)
20019 return;
20020 }
20021 else
20022 {
20023 decl = NULL_TREE;
20024 newloc = NULL;
20025 }
20026
20027 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
20028 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
20029 create a new label and emit it. */
20030 if (last_label == NULL)
20031 {
20032 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
20033 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
20034 loclabel_num++;
20035 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
20036 }
20037
20038 if (!var_loc_p)
20039 {
20040 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
20041 = ggc_alloc_cleared_call_arg_loc_node ();
20042 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (loc_note), x;
20043 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
20044 ca_loc->next = NULL;
20045 ca_loc->label = last_label;
20046 gcc_assert (prev
20047 && (CALL_P (prev)
20048 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
20049 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
20050 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
20051 if (!CALL_P (prev))
20052 prev = XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0);
20053 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
20054 x = PATTERN (prev);
20055 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
20056 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
20057 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
20058 x = SET_SRC (x);
20059 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL && MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
20060 {
20061 x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
20062 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
20063 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)
20064 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
20065 ca_loc->symbol_ref = x;
20066 }
20067 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
20068 if (call_arg_locations)
20069 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
20070 else
20071 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
20072 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
20073 }
20074 else if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
20075 newloc->label = last_label;
20076 else
20077 {
20078 if (!last_postcall_label)
20079 {
20080 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
20081 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
20082 }
20083 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
20084 }
20085
20086 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
20087 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
20088 }
20089
20090 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
20091
20092 static int
20093 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20094 {
20095 var_loc_list *list = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
20096 if (list->first)
20097 list->last_before_switch
20098 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
20099 return 1;
20100 }
20101
20102 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
20103
20104 static void
20105 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
20106 {
20107 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
20108 return;
20109
20110 htab_traverse (decl_loc_table, var_location_switch_text_section_1, NULL);
20111 }
20112
20113 /* Create a new line number table. */
20114
20115 static dw_line_info_table *
20116 new_line_info_table (void)
20117 {
20118 dw_line_info_table *table;
20119
20120 table = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_line_info_table_struct ();
20121 table->file_num = 1;
20122 table->line_num = 1;
20123 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
20124
20125 return table;
20126 }
20127
20128 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
20129 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
20130
20131 static void
20132 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
20133 {
20134 dw_line_info_table *table;
20135
20136 if (sec == text_section)
20137 table = text_section_line_info;
20138 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
20139 {
20140 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
20141 if (!table)
20142 {
20143 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
20144 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
20145 }
20146 }
20147 else
20148 {
20149 const char *end_label;
20150
20151 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
20152 {
20153 if (in_cold_section_p)
20154 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
20155 else
20156 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
20157 }
20158 else
20159 {
20160 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20161 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
20162 current_function_funcdef_no);
20163 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
20164 }
20165
20166 table = new_line_info_table ();
20167 table->end_label = end_label;
20168
20169 VEC_safe_push (dw_line_info_table_p, gc, separate_line_info, table);
20170 }
20171
20172 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
20173 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
20174 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
20175 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
20176 cur_line_info_table = table;
20177 }
20178
20179
20180 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
20181 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
20182 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
20183 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
20184
20185 static void
20186 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
20187 {
20188 section *sec = function_section (fun);
20189
20190 if (sec != text_section)
20191 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
20192
20193 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && !cold_text_section)
20194 {
20195 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
20196 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
20197 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
20198 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
20199 switch_to_section (sec);
20200 }
20201
20202 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
20203 call_site_count = 0;
20204 tail_call_site_count = 0;
20205
20206 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
20207 }
20208
20209 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
20210
20211 static void
20212 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
20213 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
20214 {
20215 dw_line_info_entry e;
20216 e.opcode = opcode;
20217 e.val = val;
20218 VEC_safe_push (dw_line_info_entry, gc, table->entries, &e);
20219 }
20220
20221 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
20222 and record information relating to this source line, in
20223 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
20224 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
20225
20226 static void
20227 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
20228 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
20229 {
20230 unsigned int file_num;
20231 dw_line_info_table *table;
20232
20233 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL || line == 0)
20234 return;
20235
20236 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
20237 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
20238 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
20239 discriminator = 0;
20240
20241 table = cur_line_info_table;
20242 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
20243
20244 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
20245 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
20246 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
20247 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
20248 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
20249 that second line number entry. */
20250 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
20251 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
20252 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
20253 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
20254 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
20255 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
20256 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
20257
20258 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
20259 && line == table->line_num
20260 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
20261 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
20262 return;
20263
20264 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
20265
20266 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
20267 if (flag_debug_asm)
20268 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START, filename, line);
20269
20270 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
20271 {
20272 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
20273 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
20274 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
20275 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
20276 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
20277 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
20278 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
20279 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
20280 putc ('0', asm_out_file);
20281
20282 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
20283 {
20284 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
20285 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
20286 }
20287 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
20288 {
20289 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
20290 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
20291 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
20292 }
20293 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
20294 }
20295 else
20296 {
20297 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
20298
20299 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
20300
20301 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
20302 if (file_num != table->file_num)
20303 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
20304 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
20305 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
20306 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
20307 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
20308 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
20309 }
20310
20311 table->file_num = file_num;
20312 table->line_num = line;
20313 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
20314 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
20315 table->in_use = true;
20316 }
20317
20318 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
20319
20320 static void
20321 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
20322 {
20323 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
20324 {
20325 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
20326 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
20327
20328 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
20329 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
20330 }
20331
20332 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20333 {
20334 macinfo_entry e;
20335 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
20336 e.lineno = lineno;
20337 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
20338 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
20339 }
20340 }
20341
20342 /* Record the end of a source file. */
20343
20344 static void
20345 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20346 {
20347 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
20348 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
20349 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
20350
20351 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20352 {
20353 macinfo_entry e;
20354 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
20355 e.lineno = lineno;
20356 e.info = NULL;
20357 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
20358 }
20359 }
20360
20361 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
20362 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
20363 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
20364
20365 static void
20366 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20367 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20368 {
20369 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20370 {
20371 macinfo_entry e;
20372 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
20373 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
20374 if (VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table) && lineno <= 1)
20375 {
20376 e.code = 0;
20377 e.lineno = 0;
20378 e.info = NULL;
20379 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
20380 }
20381 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
20382 e.lineno = lineno;
20383 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
20384 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
20385 }
20386 }
20387
20388 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
20389 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
20390 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
20391
20392 static void
20393 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20394 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20395 {
20396 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20397 {
20398 macinfo_entry e;
20399 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
20400 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
20401 if (VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table) && lineno <= 1)
20402 {
20403 e.code = 0;
20404 e.lineno = 0;
20405 e.info = NULL;
20406 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
20407 }
20408 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
20409 e.lineno = lineno;
20410 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
20411 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
20412 }
20413 }
20414
20415 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
20416
20417 static hashval_t
20418 htab_macinfo_hash (const void *of)
20419 {
20420 const macinfo_entry *const entry =
20421 (const macinfo_entry *) of;
20422
20423 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
20424 }
20425
20426 static int
20427 htab_macinfo_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
20428 {
20429 const macinfo_entry *const entry1 = (const macinfo_entry *) of1;
20430 const macinfo_entry *const entry2 = (const macinfo_entry *) of2;
20431
20432 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
20433 }
20434
20435 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
20436
20437 static void
20438 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
20439 {
20440 int file_num;
20441 size_t len;
20442 struct indirect_string_node *node;
20443 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20444 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
20445
20446 switch (ref->code)
20447 {
20448 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
20449 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
20450 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
20451 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
20452 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
20453 "Included from line number %lu",
20454 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
20455 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
20456 break;
20457 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
20458 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
20459 break;
20460 case DW_MACINFO_define:
20461 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
20462 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
20463 if (!dwarf_strict
20464 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
20465 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
20466 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
20467 {
20468 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
20469 ? DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
20470 : DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect;
20471 output_macinfo_op (ref);
20472 return;
20473 }
20474 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
20475 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
20476 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
20477 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
20478 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
20479 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
20480 break;
20481 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
20482 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
20483 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
20484 if (node->form != DW_FORM_strp)
20485 {
20486 char label[32];
20487 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
20488 ++dw2_string_counter;
20489 node->label = xstrdup (label);
20490 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
20491 }
20492 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
20493 ref->code == DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
20494 ? "Define macro indirect"
20495 : "Undefine macro indirect");
20496 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
20497 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
20498 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
20499 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
20500 ref->info);
20501 break;
20502 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
20503 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Transparent include");
20504 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
20505 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, ref->lineno);
20506 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
20507 break;
20508 default:
20509 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
20510 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
20511 break;
20512 }
20513 }
20514
20515 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
20516 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
20517 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
20518 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
20519 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entry referencing it.
20520 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
20521
20522 static unsigned
20523 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, VEC (macinfo_entry, gc) *files,
20524 htab_t *macinfo_htab)
20525 {
20526 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
20527 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
20528 unsigned char checksum[16];
20529 struct md5_ctx ctx;
20530 char *grp_name, *tail;
20531 const char *base;
20532 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
20533 void **slot;
20534
20535 first = VEC_index (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, idx);
20536 second = VEC_index (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, idx + 1);
20537
20538 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
20539 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
20540 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
20541 in some included header file. */
20542 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
20543 return 0;
20544 if (VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, files))
20545 {
20546 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
20547 return 0;
20548 }
20549 else if (first->lineno == 0)
20550 return 0;
20551
20552 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
20553 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
20554 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
20555 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
20556 for (i = idx; VEC_iterate (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, i, cur); i++)
20557 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
20558 break;
20559 else if (VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, files) && cur->lineno > 1)
20560 break;
20561 else
20562 {
20563 unsigned char code = cur->code;
20564 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
20565 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
20566 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
20567 }
20568 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
20569 count = i - idx;
20570
20571 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
20572 usable characters from its basename. */
20573 if (VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, files))
20574 base = "";
20575 else
20576 base = lbasename (VEC_last (macinfo_entry, files)->info);
20577 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
20578 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
20579 encoded_filename_len++;
20580 /* Count . at the end. */
20581 if (encoded_filename_len)
20582 encoded_filename_len++;
20583
20584 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
20585 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
20586
20587 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
20588 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
20589 + 16 * 2 + 1);
20590 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
20591 tail = grp_name + 4;
20592 if (encoded_filename_len)
20593 {
20594 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
20595 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
20596 *tail++ = base[i];
20597 *tail++ = '.';
20598 }
20599 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
20600 tail += linebuf_len;
20601 *tail++ = '.';
20602 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
20603 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
20604
20605 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include
20606 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
20607 inc = VEC_index (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, idx - 1);
20608 inc->code = DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include;
20609 inc->lineno = 0;
20610 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
20611 if (*macinfo_htab == NULL)
20612 *macinfo_htab = htab_create (10, htab_macinfo_hash, htab_macinfo_eq, NULL);
20613 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
20614 slot = htab_find_slot (*macinfo_htab, inc, INSERT);
20615 if (*slot != NULL)
20616 {
20617 inc->code = 0;
20618 inc->info = NULL;
20619 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
20620 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op. */
20621 inc = (macinfo_entry *) *slot;
20622 output_macinfo_op (inc);
20623 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
20624 in the second pass. */
20625 for (i = idx;
20626 VEC_iterate (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, i, cur)
20627 && i < idx + count;
20628 i++)
20629 {
20630 cur->code = 0;
20631 cur->info = NULL;
20632 }
20633 }
20634 else
20635 {
20636 *slot = inc;
20637 inc->lineno = htab_elements (*macinfo_htab);
20638 output_macinfo_op (inc);
20639 }
20640 return count;
20641 }
20642
20643 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
20644
20645 static void
20646 output_macinfo (void)
20647 {
20648 unsigned i;
20649 unsigned long length = VEC_length (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table);
20650 macinfo_entry *ref;
20651 VEC (macinfo_entry, gc) *files = NULL;
20652 htab_t macinfo_htab = NULL;
20653
20654 if (! length)
20655 return;
20656
20657 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
20658 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_define
20659 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_undef
20660 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_start_file
20661 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_end_file);
20662
20663 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
20664 if (!dwarf_strict)
20665 {
20666 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
20667 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
20668 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
20669 else
20670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
20671 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_line_section_label,
20672 debug_line_section, NULL);
20673 }
20674
20675 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
20676 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
20677 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
20678 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include, the
20679 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op is emitted and kept in
20680 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
20681 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
20682 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, i, ref); i++)
20683 {
20684 switch (ref->code)
20685 {
20686 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
20687 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, files, ref);
20688 break;
20689 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
20690 if (!VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, files))
20691 VEC_pop (macinfo_entry, files);
20692 break;
20693 case DW_MACINFO_define:
20694 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
20695 if (!dwarf_strict
20696 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
20697 && VEC_length (macinfo_entry, files) != 1
20698 && i > 0
20699 && i + 1 < length
20700 && VEC_index (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, i - 1)->code == 0)
20701 {
20702 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
20703 if (count)
20704 {
20705 i += count - 1;
20706 continue;
20707 }
20708 }
20709 break;
20710 case 0:
20711 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
20712 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
20713 if (i == 0)
20714 continue;
20715 default:
20716 break;
20717 }
20718 output_macinfo_op (ref);
20719 ref->info = NULL;
20720 ref->code = 0;
20721 }
20722
20723 if (macinfo_htab == NULL)
20724 return;
20725
20726 htab_delete (macinfo_htab);
20727
20728 /* If any DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include were used, on those
20729 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entries terminate the
20730 current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
20731 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
20732 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, i, ref); i++)
20733 switch (ref->code)
20734 {
20735 case 0:
20736 continue;
20737 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
20738 {
20739 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20740 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
20741 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
20742 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
20743 targetm.asm_out.named_section (DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
20744 SECTION_DEBUG
20745 | SECTION_LINKONCE,
20746 comdat_key);
20747 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
20748 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
20749 ref->lineno);
20750 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
20751 ref->code = 0;
20752 ref->info = NULL;
20753 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
20754 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
20755 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
20756 else
20757 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
20758 }
20759 break;
20760 case DW_MACINFO_define:
20761 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
20762 output_macinfo_op (ref);
20763 ref->code = 0;
20764 ref->info = NULL;
20765 break;
20766 default:
20767 gcc_unreachable ();
20768 }
20769 }
20770
20771 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
20772
20773 static void
20774 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20775 {
20776 /* Allocate the file_table. */
20777 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
20778 file_table_eq, NULL);
20779
20780 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
20781 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
20782 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
20783
20784 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
20785 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
20786 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
20787
20788 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
20789 cached_dw_loc_list_table
20790 = htab_create_ggc (10, cached_dw_loc_list_table_hash,
20791 cached_dw_loc_list_table_eq, NULL);
20792
20793 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
20794 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
20795
20796 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
20797 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_die_ref
20798 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
20799 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20800 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
20801 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
20802
20803 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
20804 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
20805 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
20806
20807 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
20808
20809 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
20810
20811 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
20812 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20813 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
20814 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20815 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
20816 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20817 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (dwarf_strict
20818 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
20819 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
20820 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20821 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
20822 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20823 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
20824 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20825 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
20826 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20827 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
20828 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20829 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
20830 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
20831 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
20832 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20833 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
20834 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20835
20836 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
20837 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
20838 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20839 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20840 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
20841 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20842 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
20843
20844 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
20845 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20846 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
20847 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20848 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
20849 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20850 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
20851 dwarf_strict
20852 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
20853 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20854
20855 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20856 macinfo_table = VEC_alloc (macinfo_entry, gc, 64);
20857
20858 switch_to_section (text_section);
20859 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
20860
20861 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
20862 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
20863 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
20864 }
20865
20866 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
20867 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
20868
20869 static void
20870 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
20871 {
20872 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
20873 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
20874 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
20875 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
20876 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
20877 }
20878
20879 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
20880 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
20881
20882 static int
20883 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20884 {
20885 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
20886
20887 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
20888 {
20889 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
20890 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
20891 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
20892 }
20893
20894 return 1;
20895 }
20896
20897 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
20898 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
20899
20900 static void
20901 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
20902 {
20903 dw_die_ref c;
20904
20905 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
20906 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
20907 }
20908 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
20909
20910 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
20911 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
20912
20913 static void
20914 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
20915 {
20916 dw_die_ref c;
20917
20918 if (die->die_mark)
20919 die->die_mark = 0;
20920 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
20921 }
20922
20923 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
20924 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
20925
20926 static void
20927 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
20928 {
20929 dw_attr_ref a;
20930 unsigned ix;
20931
20932 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
20933 {
20934 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
20935 {
20936 /* A reference to another DIE.
20937 Make sure that it will get emitted.
20938 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
20939 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
20940 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
20941 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
20942 }
20943 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
20944 accounts properly for it. */
20945 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
20946 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
20947 }
20948 }
20949
20950 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
20951
20952 static void
20953 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
20954 {
20955 dw_die_ref c;
20956
20957 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
20958 return;
20959 c = die->die_child;
20960 do
20961 {
20962 switch (c->die_tag)
20963 {
20964 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
20965 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
20966 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
20967 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
20968 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
20969 break;
20970 default:
20971 break;
20972 }
20973 c = c->die_sib;
20974 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
20975 }
20976
20977 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
20978 to DIE's children. */
20979
20980 static void
20981 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
20982 {
20983 dw_die_ref c;
20984
20985 if (die->die_mark == 0)
20986 {
20987 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
20988 die->die_mark = 1;
20989 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
20990 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
20991 args. */
20992 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
20993
20994 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
20995 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
20996 if (die->die_parent)
20997 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
20998
20999 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
21000 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
21001
21002 /* If this node is a specification,
21003 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
21004 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
21005 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
21006 }
21007
21008 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
21009 {
21010 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
21011 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
21012 die->die_mark = 2;
21013
21014 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
21015 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
21016 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
21017 for all type definitions. */
21018 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
21019 || (use_debug_types
21020 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
21021 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
21022 else
21023 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
21024 }
21025 }
21026
21027 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
21028 and if so, mark them. */
21029
21030 static void
21031 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
21032 {
21033 dw_die_ref c;
21034
21035 if (die->die_mark == 2)
21036 return;
21037
21038 switch (die->die_tag)
21039 {
21040 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
21041 case DW_TAG_union_type:
21042 case DW_TAG_class_type:
21043 break;
21044
21045 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
21046 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
21047 || die->die_definition != NULL)
21048 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
21049 return;
21050
21051 default:
21052 return;
21053 }
21054
21055 /* Mark children. */
21056 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
21057 }
21058
21059 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
21060
21061 static void
21062 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
21063 {
21064 dw_die_ref c;
21065
21066 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
21067 children have been marked as well. */
21068 if (die->die_mark == 2)
21069 return;
21070
21071 switch (die->die_tag)
21072 {
21073 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
21074 case DW_TAG_union_type:
21075 case DW_TAG_class_type:
21076 if (die->die_perennial_p)
21077 break;
21078
21079 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
21080 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
21081 break;
21082
21083 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
21084 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
21085 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
21086 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
21087 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
21088 if (c)
21089 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
21090
21091 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
21092 return;
21093
21094 case DW_TAG_const_type:
21095 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
21096 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
21097 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
21098 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
21099 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
21100 case DW_TAG_typedef:
21101 case DW_TAG_array_type:
21102 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
21103 case DW_TAG_friend:
21104 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
21105 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
21106 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
21107 case DW_TAG_string_type:
21108 case DW_TAG_set_type:
21109 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
21110 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
21111 case DW_TAG_file_type:
21112 if (die->die_perennial_p)
21113 break;
21114
21115 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
21116 return;
21117
21118 default:
21119 /* Mark everything else. */
21120 break;
21121 }
21122
21123 if (die->die_mark == 0)
21124 {
21125 die->die_mark = 1;
21126
21127 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
21128 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
21129 }
21130
21131 die->die_mark = 2;
21132
21133 /* Mark children. */
21134 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
21135 }
21136
21137 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
21138 attributes. */
21139
21140 static void
21141 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
21142 {
21143 dw_attr_ref a;
21144 unsigned ix;
21145
21146 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
21147 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
21148 {
21149 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
21150 s->refcount++;
21151 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
21152 twice in the hash table. */
21153 if (s->refcount
21154 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
21155 {
21156 void ** slot;
21157 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
21158 htab_hash_string (s->str),
21159 INSERT);
21160 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
21161 *slot = s;
21162 }
21163 }
21164 }
21165
21166 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
21167
21168 static void
21169 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
21170 {
21171 dw_die_ref c;
21172
21173 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
21174 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
21175
21176 if (! die->die_child)
21177 return;
21178
21179 c = die->die_child;
21180 do {
21181 dw_die_ref prev = c;
21182 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
21183 if (c == die->die_child)
21184 {
21185 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
21186 if (prev == c)
21187 /* No marked children at all. */
21188 die->die_child = NULL;
21189 else
21190 {
21191 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
21192 die->die_child = prev;
21193 }
21194 return;
21195 }
21196
21197 if (c != prev->die_sib)
21198 prev->die_sib = c;
21199 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
21200 } while (c != die->die_child);
21201 }
21202
21203 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
21204
21205 static void
21206 prune_unused_types (void)
21207 {
21208 unsigned int i;
21209 limbo_die_node *node;
21210 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
21211 pubname_ref pub;
21212 dw_die_ref base_type;
21213
21214 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
21215 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
21216 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
21217 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21218 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
21219 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21220 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
21221 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
21222
21223 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
21224 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
21225
21226 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
21227 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
21228 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21229 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
21230 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21231 {
21232 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
21233 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
21234 }
21235
21236 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
21237 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
21238 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
21239 not as roots in themselves. */
21240 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub)
21241 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
21242 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
21243 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_die_ref, base_types, i, base_type); i++)
21244 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
21245
21246 if (debug_str_hash)
21247 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
21248 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
21249 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21250 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
21251 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21252 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
21253
21254 /* Leave the marks clear. */
21255 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
21256 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21257 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
21258 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21259 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
21260 }
21261
21262 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
21263 the file table. */
21264 static int
21265 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
21266 {
21267 bool *p = (bool *) param;
21268 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
21269 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
21270 {
21271 *p = true;
21272 return 0;
21273 }
21274 return 1;
21275 }
21276
21277 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
21278
21279 static hashval_t
21280 htab_ct_hash (const void *of)
21281 {
21282 hashval_t h;
21283 const comdat_type_node *const type_node = (const comdat_type_node *) of;
21284
21285 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
21286 return h;
21287 }
21288
21289 static int
21290 htab_ct_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
21291 {
21292 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_1 = (const comdat_type_node *) of1;
21293 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_2 = (const comdat_type_node *) of2;
21294
21295 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
21296 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
21297 }
21298
21299 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
21300 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
21301 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
21302 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
21303 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
21304 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
21305
21306 static inline void
21307 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
21308 {
21309 unsigned ix = VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
21310 dw_attr_node linkage = *VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
21311
21312 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
21313 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
21314
21315 while (--ix > 0)
21316 {
21317 dw_attr_node *prev = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
21318
21319 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
21320 break;
21321 }
21322
21323 if (ix != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr) - 1)
21324 {
21325 VEC_pop (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
21326 VEC_quick_insert (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, &linkage);
21327 }
21328 }
21329
21330 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
21331 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
21332
21333 static void
21334 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
21335 {
21336 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
21337
21338 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
21339 {
21340 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
21341 {
21342 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
21343 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
21344 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
21345 break;
21346 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
21347 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
21348 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
21349 continue;
21350 /* FALLTHRU */
21351 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
21352 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
21353 break;
21354 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
21355 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
21356 continue;
21357 default:
21358 continue;
21359 }
21360 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
21361 if (base_type->die_mark)
21362 base_type->die_mark++;
21363 else
21364 {
21365 VEC_safe_push (dw_die_ref, heap, base_types, base_type);
21366 base_type->die_mark = 1;
21367 }
21368 }
21369 }
21370
21371 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
21372
21373 static int
21374 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
21375 {
21376 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
21377 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
21378 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
21379 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
21380 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
21381 return -1;
21382 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
21383 return 1;
21384 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
21385 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
21386 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
21387 return 1;
21388 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
21389 return -1;
21390 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
21391 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
21392 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
21393 return 1;
21394 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
21395 return -1;
21396 return 0;
21397 }
21398
21399 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
21400 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
21401 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
21402 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
21403 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
21404
21405 static void
21406 move_marked_base_types (void)
21407 {
21408 unsigned int i;
21409 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
21410
21411 if (VEC_empty (dw_die_ref, base_types))
21412 return;
21413
21414 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
21415 order later on. */
21416 VEC_qsort (dw_die_ref, base_types, base_type_cmp);
21417 die = comp_unit_die ();
21418 c = die->die_child;
21419 do
21420 {
21421 dw_die_ref prev = c;
21422 c = c->die_sib;
21423 while (c->die_mark)
21424 {
21425 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
21426 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
21427 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
21428 gcc_assert (c != c->die_sib);
21429 c = c->die_sib;
21430 }
21431 }
21432 while (c != die->die_child);
21433 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
21434 c = die->die_child;
21435 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_die_ref, base_types, i, base_type); i++)
21436 {
21437 base_type->die_mark = 0;
21438 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
21439 c->die_sib = base_type;
21440 c = base_type;
21441 }
21442 }
21443
21444 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
21445 one CONST_STRING, return non-zero if not successful. Similarly verify that
21446 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
21447
21448 static int
21449 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21450 {
21451 rtx rtl = *addr;
21452
21453 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
21454 {
21455 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
21456 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
21457 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
21458 TREE_TYPE (t)
21459 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
21460 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
21461 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
21462 return 1;
21463 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
21464 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
21465 *addr = rtl;
21466 return 0;
21467 }
21468
21469 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
21470 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
21471 {
21472 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
21473 {
21474 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
21475 return 1;
21476 }
21477 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
21478 return 1;
21479 }
21480
21481 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
21482 && for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), resolve_one_addr, NULL))
21483 return 1;
21484
21485 return 0;
21486 }
21487
21488 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
21489 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
21490 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
21491
21492 static bool
21493 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
21494 {
21495 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
21496 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
21497 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
21498 {
21499 case DW_OP_addr:
21500 if (resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
21501 return false;
21502 break;
21503 case DW_OP_const4u:
21504 case DW_OP_const8u:
21505 if (loc->dtprel
21506 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
21507 return false;
21508 break;
21509 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
21510 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
21511 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
21512 + 1
21513 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
21514 {
21515 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
21516 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
21517 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
21518 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
21519 *loc = *repl;
21520 }
21521 break;
21522 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
21523 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
21524 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr, NULL))
21525 return false;
21526 break;
21527 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
21528 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
21529 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
21530 {
21531 dw_die_ref ref
21532 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
21533 if (ref == NULL)
21534 return false;
21535 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
21536 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
21537 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
21538 }
21539 break;
21540 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
21541 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
21542 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
21543 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
21544 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
21545 while (loc->dw_loc_next
21546 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert)
21547 {
21548 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
21549 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
21550 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
21551 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
21552 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
21553 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
21554 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
21555 break;
21556 else
21557 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
21558 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
21559 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
21560 break;
21561 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
21562 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
21563 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
21564 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
21565 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
21566 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
21567 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
21568 if (size1 == size2
21569 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
21570 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
21571 && loc != keep)
21572 || enc1 == enc2))
21573 {
21574 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_GNU_convert after
21575 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
21576 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
21577 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
21578 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
21579 else
21580 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
21581 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
21582 continue;
21583 }
21584 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_GNU_convert after e.g. floating
21585 point typed stack entry. */
21586 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
21587 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
21588 break;
21589 }
21590 break;
21591 default:
21592 break;
21593 }
21594 return true;
21595 }
21596
21597 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
21598 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
21599 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
21600 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
21601 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
21602 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
21603
21604 static void
21605 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
21606 {
21607 dw_die_ref c;
21608 dw_attr_ref a;
21609 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
21610 unsigned ix;
21611
21612 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
21613 switch (AT_class (a))
21614 {
21615 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
21616 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
21617 loc = *curr;
21618 gcc_assert (loc);
21619 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
21620 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
21621 if (loc->replaced)
21622 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
21623 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
21624 {
21625 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
21626 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
21627 References must be identical or completely separate.
21628 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
21629 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
21630 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
21631 while (*curr)
21632 {
21633 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
21634 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
21635 {
21636 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
21637 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
21638 {
21639 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
21640 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
21641 }
21642 *curr = next;
21643 }
21644 else
21645 {
21646 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
21647 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
21648 }
21649 }
21650 if (loc == *start)
21651 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
21652 else
21653 {
21654 loc->replaced = 1;
21655 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
21656 }
21657 }
21658 if (!*start)
21659 {
21660 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
21661 ix--;
21662 }
21663 break;
21664 case dw_val_class_loc:
21665 {
21666 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
21667 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
21668 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
21669 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
21670 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
21671 but shorter, location description. */
21672 if ((dwarf_version > 2
21673 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
21674 || l == NULL
21675 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
21676 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
21677 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (l))
21678 {
21679 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
21680 ix--;
21681 }
21682 else
21683 mark_base_types (l);
21684 }
21685 break;
21686 case dw_val_class_addr:
21687 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
21688 && resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr, NULL))
21689 {
21690 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
21691 ix--;
21692 }
21693 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
21694 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
21695 {
21696 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
21697 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
21698 if (tdie == NULL
21699 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
21700 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE)
21701 {
21702 force_decl_die (tdecl);
21703 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
21704 }
21705 if (tdie)
21706 {
21707 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
21708 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
21709 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
21710 }
21711 else
21712 {
21713 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
21714 ix--;
21715 }
21716 }
21717 break;
21718 default:
21719 break;
21720 }
21721
21722 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
21723 }
21724 \f
21725 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
21726 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
21727 section. */
21728
21729 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode. */
21730
21731 static inline hashval_t
21732 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, hashval_t hash)
21733 {
21734 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
21735 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
21736
21737 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
21738 {
21739 case DW_OP_const4u:
21740 case DW_OP_const8u:
21741 if (loc->dtprel)
21742 goto hash_addr;
21743 /* FALLTHRU */
21744 case DW_OP_const1u:
21745 case DW_OP_const1s:
21746 case DW_OP_const2u:
21747 case DW_OP_const2s:
21748 case DW_OP_const4s:
21749 case DW_OP_const8s:
21750 case DW_OP_constu:
21751 case DW_OP_consts:
21752 case DW_OP_pick:
21753 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
21754 case DW_OP_breg0:
21755 case DW_OP_breg1:
21756 case DW_OP_breg2:
21757 case DW_OP_breg3:
21758 case DW_OP_breg4:
21759 case DW_OP_breg5:
21760 case DW_OP_breg6:
21761 case DW_OP_breg7:
21762 case DW_OP_breg8:
21763 case DW_OP_breg9:
21764 case DW_OP_breg10:
21765 case DW_OP_breg11:
21766 case DW_OP_breg12:
21767 case DW_OP_breg13:
21768 case DW_OP_breg14:
21769 case DW_OP_breg15:
21770 case DW_OP_breg16:
21771 case DW_OP_breg17:
21772 case DW_OP_breg18:
21773 case DW_OP_breg19:
21774 case DW_OP_breg20:
21775 case DW_OP_breg21:
21776 case DW_OP_breg22:
21777 case DW_OP_breg23:
21778 case DW_OP_breg24:
21779 case DW_OP_breg25:
21780 case DW_OP_breg26:
21781 case DW_OP_breg27:
21782 case DW_OP_breg28:
21783 case DW_OP_breg29:
21784 case DW_OP_breg30:
21785 case DW_OP_breg31:
21786 case DW_OP_regx:
21787 case DW_OP_fbreg:
21788 case DW_OP_piece:
21789 case DW_OP_deref_size:
21790 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
21791 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_int, hash);
21792 break;
21793 case DW_OP_skip:
21794 case DW_OP_bra:
21795 {
21796 int offset;
21797
21798 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
21799 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
21800 hash = iterative_hash_object (offset, hash);
21801 }
21802 break;
21803 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
21804 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_unsigned, hash);
21805 switch (val2->val_class)
21806 {
21807 case dw_val_class_const:
21808 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
21809 break;
21810 case dw_val_class_vec:
21811 {
21812 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
21813 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
21814
21815 hash = iterative_hash_object (elt_size, hash);
21816 hash = iterative_hash_object (len, hash);
21817 hash = iterative_hash (val2->v.val_vec.array,
21818 len * elt_size, hash);
21819 }
21820 break;
21821 case dw_val_class_const_double:
21822 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.low, hash);
21823 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.high, hash);
21824 break;
21825 case dw_val_class_addr:
21826 hash = iterative_hash_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hash);
21827 break;
21828 default:
21829 gcc_unreachable ();
21830 }
21831 break;
21832 case DW_OP_bregx:
21833 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
21834 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_int, hash);
21835 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
21836 break;
21837 case DW_OP_addr:
21838 hash_addr:
21839 if (loc->dtprel)
21840 {
21841 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
21842 hash = iterative_hash_object (dtprel, hash);
21843 }
21844 hash = iterative_hash_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hash);
21845 break;
21846 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
21847 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
21848 break;
21849 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
21850 hash = hash_loc_operands (val1->v.val_loc, hash);
21851 break;
21852 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
21853 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
21854 {
21855 unsigned int byte_size
21856 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
21857 unsigned int encoding
21858 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
21859 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_int, hash);
21860 hash = iterative_hash_object (byte_size, hash);
21861 hash = iterative_hash_object (encoding, hash);
21862 }
21863 break;
21864 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
21865 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
21866 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
21867 {
21868 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_unsigned, hash);
21869 break;
21870 }
21871 /* FALLTHRU */
21872 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
21873 {
21874 unsigned int byte_size
21875 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
21876 unsigned int encoding
21877 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
21878 hash = iterative_hash_object (byte_size, hash);
21879 hash = iterative_hash_object (encoding, hash);
21880 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
21881 break;
21882 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->val_class, hash);
21883 switch (val2->val_class)
21884 {
21885 case dw_val_class_const:
21886 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
21887 break;
21888 case dw_val_class_vec:
21889 {
21890 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
21891 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
21892
21893 hash = iterative_hash_object (elt_size, hash);
21894 hash = iterative_hash_object (len, hash);
21895 hash = iterative_hash (val2->v.val_vec.array,
21896 len * elt_size, hash);
21897 }
21898 break;
21899 case dw_val_class_const_double:
21900 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.low, hash);
21901 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.high, hash);
21902 break;
21903 default:
21904 gcc_unreachable ();
21905 }
21906 }
21907 break;
21908
21909 default:
21910 /* Other codes have no operands. */
21911 break;
21912 }
21913 return hash;
21914 }
21915
21916 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC. */
21917
21918 static inline hashval_t
21919 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, hashval_t hash)
21920 {
21921 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
21922 bool sizes_computed = false;
21923 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
21924 size_of_locs (loc);
21925
21926 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
21927 {
21928 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
21929 hash = iterative_hash_object (opc, hash);
21930 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
21931 {
21932 size_of_locs (loc);
21933 sizes_computed = true;
21934 }
21935 hash = hash_loc_operands (l, hash);
21936 }
21937 return hash;
21938 }
21939
21940 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
21941
21942 static inline void
21943 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
21944 {
21945 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
21946 hashval_t hash = 0;
21947
21948 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
21949 {
21950 hash = iterative_hash (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1, hash);
21951 hash = iterative_hash (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1, hash);
21952 if (curr->section)
21953 hash = iterative_hash (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1,
21954 hash);
21955 hash = hash_locs (curr->expr, hash);
21956 }
21957 list_head->hash = hash;
21958 }
21959
21960 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
21961
21962 static inline bool
21963 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
21964 {
21965 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
21966 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
21967 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
21968 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
21969
21970 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
21971 {
21972 case DW_OP_const4u:
21973 case DW_OP_const8u:
21974 if (x->dtprel)
21975 goto hash_addr;
21976 /* FALLTHRU */
21977 case DW_OP_const1u:
21978 case DW_OP_const1s:
21979 case DW_OP_const2u:
21980 case DW_OP_const2s:
21981 case DW_OP_const4s:
21982 case DW_OP_const8s:
21983 case DW_OP_constu:
21984 case DW_OP_consts:
21985 case DW_OP_pick:
21986 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
21987 case DW_OP_breg0:
21988 case DW_OP_breg1:
21989 case DW_OP_breg2:
21990 case DW_OP_breg3:
21991 case DW_OP_breg4:
21992 case DW_OP_breg5:
21993 case DW_OP_breg6:
21994 case DW_OP_breg7:
21995 case DW_OP_breg8:
21996 case DW_OP_breg9:
21997 case DW_OP_breg10:
21998 case DW_OP_breg11:
21999 case DW_OP_breg12:
22000 case DW_OP_breg13:
22001 case DW_OP_breg14:
22002 case DW_OP_breg15:
22003 case DW_OP_breg16:
22004 case DW_OP_breg17:
22005 case DW_OP_breg18:
22006 case DW_OP_breg19:
22007 case DW_OP_breg20:
22008 case DW_OP_breg21:
22009 case DW_OP_breg22:
22010 case DW_OP_breg23:
22011 case DW_OP_breg24:
22012 case DW_OP_breg25:
22013 case DW_OP_breg26:
22014 case DW_OP_breg27:
22015 case DW_OP_breg28:
22016 case DW_OP_breg29:
22017 case DW_OP_breg30:
22018 case DW_OP_breg31:
22019 case DW_OP_regx:
22020 case DW_OP_fbreg:
22021 case DW_OP_piece:
22022 case DW_OP_deref_size:
22023 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
22024 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
22025 case DW_OP_skip:
22026 case DW_OP_bra:
22027 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
22028 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
22029 && x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr);
22030 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
22031 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
22032 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
22033 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
22034 return false;
22035 switch (valx2->val_class)
22036 {
22037 case dw_val_class_const:
22038 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
22039 case dw_val_class_vec:
22040 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
22041 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
22042 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
22043 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
22044 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
22045 case dw_val_class_const_double:
22046 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
22047 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
22048 case dw_val_class_addr:
22049 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
22050 default:
22051 gcc_unreachable ();
22052 }
22053 case DW_OP_bregx:
22054 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
22055 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
22056 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
22057 case DW_OP_addr:
22058 hash_addr:
22059 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
22060 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
22061 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
22062 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
22063 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
22064 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
22065 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
22066 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
22067 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
22068 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
22069 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
22070 return false;
22071 switch (valx2->val_class)
22072 {
22073 case dw_val_class_const:
22074 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
22075 case dw_val_class_vec:
22076 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
22077 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
22078 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
22079 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
22080 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
22081 case dw_val_class_const_double:
22082 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
22083 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
22084 default:
22085 gcc_unreachable ();
22086 }
22087 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
22088 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
22089 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
22090 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
22091 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
22092 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
22093 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
22094 return false;
22095 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
22096 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
22097 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
22098 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
22099 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
22100 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
22101 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
22102 default:
22103 /* Other codes have no operands. */
22104 return true;
22105 }
22106 }
22107
22108 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
22109
22110 static inline bool
22111 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
22112 {
22113 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
22114 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
22115 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
22116 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
22117 break;
22118 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
22119 }
22120
22121 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
22122
22123 static hashval_t
22124 loc_list_hash (const void *x)
22125 {
22126 return ((const struct dw_loc_list_struct *) x)->hash;
22127 }
22128
22129 /* Return 1 if location lists X and Y are the same. */
22130
22131 static int
22132 loc_list_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
22133 {
22134 const struct dw_loc_list_struct *a = (const struct dw_loc_list_struct *) x;
22135 const struct dw_loc_list_struct *b = (const struct dw_loc_list_struct *) y;
22136 if (a == b)
22137 return 1;
22138 if (a->hash != b->hash)
22139 return 0;
22140 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
22141 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
22142 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
22143 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
22144 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
22145 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
22146 break;
22147 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
22148 }
22149
22150 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
22151 children and share them whenever possible. */
22152
22153 static void
22154 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, htab_t htab)
22155 {
22156 dw_die_ref c;
22157 dw_attr_ref a;
22158 unsigned ix;
22159 void **slot;
22160
22161 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
22162 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
22163 {
22164 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
22165 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
22166 it and storing into the hash table. */
22167 hash_loc_list (list);
22168 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab, list, list->hash,
22169 INSERT);
22170 if (*slot == NULL)
22171 *slot = (void *) list;
22172 else
22173 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = (dw_loc_list_ref) *slot;
22174 }
22175
22176 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
22177 }
22178
22179 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
22180 children and share them whenever possible. */
22181
22182 static void
22183 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
22184 {
22185 htab_t htab = htab_create (500, loc_list_hash, loc_list_eq, NULL);
22186 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, htab);
22187 htab_delete (htab);
22188 }
22189 \f
22190 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
22191 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
22192
22193 static void
22194 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
22195 {
22196 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
22197 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
22198 htab_t comdat_type_table;
22199 unsigned int i;
22200
22201 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
22202 header compilation, fix it up if needed. */
22203 dw_attr_ref producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
22204 if (strcmp (AT_string (producer), producer_string) != 0)
22205 {
22206 struct indirect_string_node *node = find_AT_string (producer_string);
22207 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
22208 }
22209
22210 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
22211 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
22212
22213 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
22214 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
22215 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
22216 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) || targetm.force_at_comp_dir)
22217 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
22218 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
22219 {
22220 bool p = false;
22221 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
22222 if (p)
22223 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
22224 }
22225
22226 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list); i++)
22227 {
22228 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
22229 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->die,
22230 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->variable,
22231 false,
22232 DW_AT_location);
22233 }
22234
22235 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
22236 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
22237 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
22238 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
22239 instance. */
22240 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
22241 {
22242 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
22243 next_node = node->next;
22244
22245 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
22246 {
22247 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
22248
22249 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
22250 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
22251 else if (is_cu_die (die))
22252 ;
22253 else if (seen_error ())
22254 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
22255 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
22256 else
22257 {
22258 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
22259 nested function can be optimized away, which results
22260 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
22261 with the return type of that nested function. Force
22262 this to be a child of the containing function.
22263
22264 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
22265 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
22266 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
22267 the function is likely unreachable too. */
22268 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
22269
22270 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
22271 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
22272 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
22273 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
22274 else
22275 origin = comp_unit_die ();
22276
22277 add_child_die (origin, die);
22278 }
22279 }
22280 }
22281
22282 limbo_die_list = NULL;
22283
22284 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
22285 {
22286 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
22287 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
22288 }
22289 #endif
22290 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
22291 move_marked_base_types ();
22292
22293 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
22294 {
22295 tree decl = node->created_for;
22296 /* When generating LTO bytecode we can not generate new assembler
22297 names at this point and all important decls got theirs via
22298 free-lang-data. */
22299 if ((!flag_generate_lto || DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
22300 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
22301 {
22302 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
22303 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
22304 }
22305 }
22306
22307 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
22308
22309 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
22310 emit full debugging info for them. */
22311 retry_incomplete_types ();
22312
22313 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
22314 prune_unused_types ();
22315
22316 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
22317 if (use_debug_types)
22318 {
22319 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
22320
22321 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
22322 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
22323 limbo die list. */
22324 limbo_die_list = NULL;
22325
22326 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
22327 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
22328 references to the main compile unit). */
22329 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22330 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
22331 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
22332
22333 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
22334 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
22335 referenced. Prune them. */
22336 prune_unused_types ();
22337 }
22338
22339 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
22340 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
22341 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
22342 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die ());
22343
22344 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
22345 that have children. */
22346 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
22347 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22348 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
22349 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22350 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
22351
22352 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
22353 switch_to_section (text_section);
22354 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
22355 if (cold_text_section)
22356 {
22357 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
22358 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
22359 }
22360
22361 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
22362 in .text. */
22363 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
22364 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
22365 {
22366 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
22367 if (text_section_used)
22368 {
22369 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
22370 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
22371 }
22372 }
22373 else
22374 {
22375 unsigned fde_idx;
22376 dw_fde_ref fde;
22377 bool range_list_added = false;
22378
22379 if (text_section_used)
22380 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), text_section_label,
22381 text_end_label, &range_list_added);
22382 if (cold_text_section_used)
22383 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), cold_text_section_label,
22384 cold_end_label, &range_list_added);
22385
22386 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_fde_ref, fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
22387 {
22388 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
22389 continue;
22390 if (!fde->in_std_section)
22391 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), fde->dw_fde_begin,
22392 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added);
22393 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
22394 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
22395 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added);
22396 }
22397
22398 if (range_list_added)
22399 {
22400 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
22401 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
22402 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
22403 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
22404 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
22405 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
22406 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
22407 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
22408
22409 add_ranges (NULL);
22410 }
22411 }
22412
22413 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22414 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list,
22415 debug_line_section_label);
22416
22417 if (have_macinfo)
22418 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (),
22419 dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros,
22420 macinfo_section_label);
22421
22422 if (have_location_lists)
22423 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
22424
22425 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
22426 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
22427 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
22428 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
22429
22430 comdat_type_table = htab_create (100, htab_ct_hash, htab_ct_eq, NULL);
22431 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
22432 {
22433 void **slot = htab_find_slot (comdat_type_table, ctnode, INSERT);
22434
22435 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
22436 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
22437 continue;
22438
22439 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
22440 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
22441 attributes. */
22442 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22443 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
22444 debug_line_section_label);
22445
22446 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
22447 *slot = ctnode;
22448 }
22449 htab_delete (comdat_type_table);
22450
22451 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
22452
22453 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
22454 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
22455 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo);
22456
22457 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
22458 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use != 1)
22459 {
22460 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
22461 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
22462 output_abbrev_section ();
22463 }
22464
22465 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
22466 if (have_location_lists)
22467 {
22468 /* Output the location lists info. */
22469 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
22470 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
22471 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22472 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
22473 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
22474 }
22475
22476 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
22477 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
22478 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
22479 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
22480 simply won't look for the section. */
22481 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
22482
22483 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
22484 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
22485 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
22486 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
22487 generate a table that would have contained data. */
22488 if (info_section_emitted)
22489 {
22490 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
22491
22492 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
22493 output_aranges (aranges_length);
22494 }
22495
22496 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
22497 if (ranges_table_in_use)
22498 {
22499 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
22500 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
22501 output_ranges ();
22502 }
22503
22504 /* Have to end the macro section. */
22505 if (have_macinfo)
22506 {
22507 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
22508 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
22509 output_macinfo ();
22510 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
22511 }
22512
22513 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
22514 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
22515 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
22516 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
22517 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
22518 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
22519 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
22520 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
22521 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
22522 output_line_info ();
22523
22524 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
22525 table too. */
22526 if (debug_str_hash)
22527 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
22528 }
22529
22530 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"